Statie Stonex r2w Manual
Statie Stonex r2w Manual
Statie Stonex r2w Manual
TECHNICAL SUPPORT
Please contact your local distributor for technical support.
-2-
Table of Contents
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Technical Support 2
Table of Contents 3
Getting Started 13
Introduction 13
Hardware Requirements 13
Installing FieldGenius 14
Starting FieldGenius 14
Registration & Demo Mode 14
Activation 15
Product Registration 16
Available Modules 16
Run Demo Mode 17
Retrieve Lost Key Codes (passwords) 17
Project Manager 17
Project Review 19
Quick Start: Open Existing Project 20
Quick Start: New Project 22
Common FieldGenius Buttons 29
FieldGenius Project Files 30
Automatic Save 31
Data Entry (Extended Edit Fields) 31
Keypad 32
Distance Entry & Recall 34
Distance Entry 34
Distance Recall 34
Unit Modifiers 34
Distance Entry Examples 35
Using Math Operations 37
Direction Entry & Recall 38
-3-
Stonex FieldGenius
Direction Entry 38
Direction Recall 38
Unit Modifiers 38
Direction Entry Examples 39
Using Math Operations 42
Main Interface 43
Two Versions of the User Interface 43
Portrait Display 44
Landscape Display 45
Toolbars 45
Display Toolbar 45
Observation Toolbar 47
3D View Toolbar 48
Total Station Toolbar 50
Robotic Total Station Toolbar 51
GNSS Toolbar 54
Disto/Laser Toolbar 56
Topo Toolbar 57
Mini Toolbar 60
Map Select Toolbar 60
Points & Figures 62
Points 62
Point Labels 62
Editing Single Points 62
Working with Multiple Points 62
Point Toolbar 62
Select Point Toolbar 64
Point Averaging 65
Partition Lines/Arcs 69
AutoMap Library 70
Feature List 74
-4-
Table of Contents
Notes 76
Lines and Figures 79
Active Linework 79
Figures 81
Line Toolbar 82
Select Line Toolbar 84
Figure List 85
Using Active Figures 87
Figure Direction Marker 90
New Figure 91
Switching Active Figures 92
3-Point Arcs 94
Splines (Curvy) Figures 96
Closing Figures 97
End (complete) a Figure 98
Re-Activating Figures 98
Deleting Figures 100
Draw Option Defaults 101
Drawing Tool 103
Smart Tags 108
Main Menu 110
Project Manager 112
Settings Menu 114
Options 115
Unit Settings 130
Coordinate Systems 133
Keyboard Shortcuts 141
Language Selection 143
AutoMap Library 144
GroupCode Editor 144
Feature List Editor 151
-5-
Stonex FieldGenius
-6-
Table of Contents
-7-
Stonex FieldGenius
-8-
Table of Contents
-9-
Stonex FieldGenius
- 10 -
Table of Contents
- 11 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 12 -
Getting Started
GETTING STARTED
Introduction
Stonex FieldGenius was designed for Land Surveying, Civil Engineering, Seismic Surveying, and
Construction Staking professionals to provide unequalled data collection simplicity and field cal-
culating performance.
The Graphic User interface allows you to build the drawing as you measure, providing you with
instant visual confirmation of accurate data collection and survey calculations. It includes the ability
to draw linework as you measure from point to point without the need for cumbersome line coding.
FieldGenius takes advantage of the Windows CE touch screen capability by allowing you to tap
points and lines in your drawing to open toolbars with all the function you need instantly. Functions
that are not available directly from FieldGenius graphics display are available from a simple main
menu which is organized by task. Please spend some time looking over this document or watch our
movies to become familiar with the functionality of FieldGenius.
Once you've collected your data in the field you can export it directly out of FieldGenius using many
different file types such as ASCII, DXF, XML, SDR, or ESRI Shapefiles. If you have Stonex Geo-
matics CAD desktop software, then you can read your FieldGenius projects into it directly.
FieldGenius raw file is based on the popular industry-standard TDS RW5 format which means you
probably already have software that can import this raw file type and process it. This means you don't
need to purchase expensive products to process your FieldGenius projects.
Importing data into FieldGenius is just as easy as exporting. You can import ASCII, XML and DXF
files directly into FieldGenius.
Our instrument control is easy to use and very powerful. Access to your instrument controls is avail-
able on the main interface at all times so there is no need to swap to other screens or menus.
As always, Stonex welcomes your comments and suggestions for our products.
Hardware Requirements
FieldGenius can be installed on various Windows Mobile, WinCE, and Windows Tablet/PC devices.
Please visit the Hardware Support page for a list of supported devices. If in doubt, please contact
Technical Support.
- 13 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Installing FieldGenius
If you purchased a new data collector with FieldGenius, FieldGenius will most likely come pre-loaded
on it.
If you are installing FieldGenius yourself onto an existing data collector, please confirm that your hard-
ware is supported by FieldGenius. If you're reading this topic then you probably already know if
FieldGenius will run on your data collector. If you're not sure, you can refer to the hardware require-
ments topic or call our technical support department.
To install onto your data collector you need to make sure you have a Microsoft ActiveSync or Win-
dows Mobile Device Center connection established between your computer and your data collector.
To install FieldGenius onto your device you will need to download the installation files from our web-
site at http://helpdesk.microsurvey.com/.
Starting FieldGenius
During install, shortcuts are created and will be located in either your Start Menu, or Start Menu | Pro-
grams, or directly on your desktop. Simply press the shortcut to start the program.
Auto Repair
Upon start-up FieldGenius checks the registry for corruption, and also checks to make sure important
system files are where they need to be for FieldGenius to run properly. If it detects any problems, it
will automatically fix them for you.
Hard Reset or Battery Drain
In these scenarios as with other software, you would usually have to re-install your software.
However, because FieldGenius can repair itself all you need to do is use the File Explorer or My Com-
puter program on your data collector to browse to where FieldGenius is installed and find the pro-
grams folder. In there, if you run the "splash" program it will automatically fix all problems and re-
install your shortcuts for you.
The splash program will be an executable file and it will include the word "splash" in it. For example on
a Windows Mobile device, the file is called SplashWM6.exe.
- 14 -
Getting Started
Activation
To activate FieldGenius you need access to the Internet. With your purchase you should have
received a serial number (also known as a Globally Unique ID, or GUID) that you will need along with
the Device ID generated by FieldGenius.
A typical serial number will look something like the following:
D9C83164-FB0E-4713-B457-CE593EFEA296
A typical Device ID will look something like the following:
F011-F38C-4421-B482
Step 1
From a computer that has access to the internet, please visit the following web page:
www.microsurvey.com/register
Follow the instructions on the FieldGenius registration pages.
NOTE: Your GUID is valid for only one activation.
Step 2
Using the Key generated by the online registration system, enter the key values into FieldGenius.
When done, press the Apply Key. You will see the words "Activation Key Valid" and it will list the mod-
ules that were registered. The Run Demo Mode button will also change to say Continue.
- 15 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Product Registration
To receive news and notifications about your product, please register your software at:
www.microsurvey.com/reg
Available Modules
There are several modules available for use on a data collector and they're as follows:
l Standard - Real-time Automated Linework, COGO Calculations, Traverse Closure and Adjust-
ments, ASCII/DXF Import/Export, Stonex Transfer, and more!
l Total Station - Adds non-robotic total station control.
l GNSS - adds RTK GNSS control, Coordinate Calculator, GNSS Local Transformations.
l Advanced - adds Surface Modeling, Roading, LandXML, GIS Attribute Collection, Pre-
determined Area Calculations
l Robotic - adds Robotic Total Station control.
l MEP - adds Auto-Locate capabilities.
- 16 -
Getting Started
Project Manager
Main Menu | Project Manager
The Project Manager is used to create, open, or delete Projects stored on your data collector. When
you start FieldGenius this is always the first screen you will see.
You can sort the list by Project name or date by tapping on the column's header.
- 17 -
Stonex FieldGenius
FG Projects Folder
Press this button to specify a different Project folder than the default. The default is
...\Stonex\FieldGenius\FG Projects\ (Windows CE/Mobile) or ...\Docu-
ments\Stonex\FieldGenius\FG Projects\ (Windows Tablet/PC). Once you set the directory it is writ-
ten to the MSurvey.ini file and is used for all subsequent Projects.
Delete Project
To delete a Project, pick the Delete trash can icon next to the Project Name. You will be asked to con-
firm that you really want to delete the Project.
Notes:
- You cannot delete a Project that is currently open
- Projects that have been deleted cannot be restored
Open Project
To open an existing Project, simply select it in the list and press the Open button.
Review & Open Project
To review and open an existing Project, simply select it in the list and press the Review & Open but-
ton. This option will display the Project files used with the Project.
New Project
To create a new Project, simply press the New Project button. You will then see the New Project
screen which will allow you to enter a name, choose your AutoMap library and set the units for the Pro-
ject.
Exit
To exit from the Project Manager press the Exit button.
- 18 -
Getting Started
Project Review
When you create a new Project or open an existing Project; you will have the option to review the Pro-
ject Files screen.
Here you can confirm the files associated with the Project and change or add files as needed.
- 19 -
Stonex FieldGenius
If you start FieldGenius in demo mode, the first screen you will see is the About screen, where you
can enter a registration code to license your copy of FieldGenius. Press the Run Demo Mode button
if you see this screen.
By default a Project named FG Sample is installed. For this example let's open it by highlighting it
and pressing the Open button. You can also double tap the file name which will also open it. Use the
Review & Open button to also review the Project files of the Project.
If you picked the Review & Open option; you will be able to review the Project files associated with
the Project and make any changes if needed.
- 20 -
Getting Started
FieldGenius will then check to see if the Project has a previous instrument setup. If one is found you
will be asked if you would like to reuse it.
The main menu will then be displayed. Press the button to access the map screen, or use any of the
available menu commands.
You may see an option to reconnect to the previous instruments on the instrument toolbar. If you are
using the same equipment, press Reconnect.
- 21 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The Map screen will then be displayed. You should now see your Project, here is what the FG Sample
Project should look like:
- 22 -
Getting Started
Next, the Project Manager appears. Press the New Project button to create a new Project.
Enter a name for your new Project. You can press OK to accept the settings and continue. If you
need to change any of the settings, press the Project Settings button.
- 23 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Project Settings
The Project Setting screen allows you to refine the various aspects of the Project and save them as
default for future Projects if desired.
- 24 -
Getting Started
Coordinate System
The Coordinate System screen allows you to select Horizontal and Vertical coordinate systems.
These settings are critical for working with GNSS equipment. Use the Save As Default button to set
these settings as defaults for all subsequent new Projects.
- 25 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Project Files
The Project Files screen allows you to specify the Raw File, the AutoMap Library Template File, and
Feature List File to use, and whether you want your raw file to be encrypted and/or appended.
Project Information
The Project Information screen allows you to enter information about the Project, crew and weather
conditions.
- 26 -
Getting Started
Press OK on the New Project screen. You will then see the Instrument Selection screen where you
are prompted to select the instrument that you want to connect to. Let's set it to Simulator and select
Total Station Demo in the Instrument Profile drop down box. Then press Connect to continue.
(Note, you will not see this screen if FieldGenius is running onboard your instrument.)
If you selected Total Station or Total Station Demo, you will then see a message asking "Would you
like to create a new point now?" Press Yes to open the Store / Edit Points screen. The default
coordinates that are displayed are retrieved from the MSurvey.ini file and if you change these coordin-
ates they will be remembered for next time. Selecting No will take you to the main interface.
- 27 -
Stonex FieldGenius
If you chose to create a reference point in the step above, you will be asked "Would you like to
setup the instrument at the new point?" Press Yes to open the Orientation Setup screen for
measuring your backsight.
Once you complete the setup routine and have measured your backsight, you will see your setup and
backsight positions in the map view.
- 28 -
Getting Started
Clicking on this button will open up the help page for whatever
topic you are currently at. The help page will open up in an Inter-
net Explorer window.
- 29 -
Stonex FieldGenius
This button will take you back to the previous menu until you are
back at the main menu.
This button will accept the input or changes, then continue to the
next screen or finish the command.
This button will close the current screen and return you to the pre-
vious screen without saving any changes.
Pressing this will close the currently open toolbar and return you
to the previous screen.
- 30 -
Getting Started
Note:
After creating a new Project, do not later rename the folder containing your Project's
files or the actual files, doing so will cause FieldGenius to not recognize the folder as
a valid Project and you will not be able to open it.
Automatic Save
There are a few things to keep in mind when manually entering data in FieldGenius:
All stored data is automatically saved. There is no need for a Save function. Always close the pro-
gram by going to the Main Menu and choose the Exit button to prevent loss of measurement data.
Input fields that are left blank are stored as undefined. For example, if you enter only a horizontal
coordinate for a point and leave the elevation field blank, we do not automatically set the elevation as
0.000. The elevation remains undefined.
- 31 -
Stonex FieldGenius
On Windows Mobile devices you can select which keypad to display by changing the "SIP Type"
option in the Options screen.
Points
When you see an extended edit field for a Point ID, tapping in it will open the point chooser toolbar.
Distance and Angles
Tapping in other numeric fields such as those for directions and distances will open the RPN Cal-
culator, and some distance fields will open the Inverse tool.
Multi-function Fields
Some fields will display a pop up menu if multiple functions can be opened from that field, just select
the desired function from the list.
Keypad
The keypad can be opened from any extended edit entry field. This provides a method of easy text
and numeric entry on devices that do not have a physical keypad but it can be used on any device.
- 32 -
Getting Started
Calculator
The RPN Scientific Calculator can be called up from the keypad by pressing the Calculator button. If
you press the Calculator button, the value entered in the keypad entry field will be copied to the cal-
culator's command line (Note, it must be a numeric value, alpha portions will be stripped off in the cal-
culator) where it can be used for any calculations. When you are done with the calculator, pressing
the OK button will return the result back into the keypad.
OK
Pressing the OK button will close the keypad, and set the entered value into the text field from which
the keypad was opened.
Cancel
Pressing the Cancel button will close the keypad without setting anything into the text field from
which the keypad was opened.
Keypad Settings
There are five important settings related to the keypad, which are both found by to going to Settings
and then the Options button that takes you to the Options screen.
Virtual Keyboard
Use this to specify which keypad type you want to use. Not all keyboard types are available on all
data collectors.
- 33 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Distance Recall
You can recall the distance between two points, by inputting in the form: FromID..ToID Example:
26..84 will be recognized as the distance computed between points 26 and 84. The distance will be
returned in whichever format your units settings is set to.
Unit Modifiers
Recognition of the unit symbols m, ', ft, usft, ftus are supported, and can be used to override the Pro-
ject's unit settings.
- 34 -
Getting Started
Meters
You can specify that a distance is in meters by entering "m" after the value, for example 100m means
100 Meters, even if your Project is in Feet. Therefore, if your Project is in US Feet and you enter
100.00m in a distance field, you will see it automatically get converted to 328.08 feet.
Feet (International or US Survey)
The ' symbol will be interpreted as either International Feet or US Survey Feet, whichever units the
current Project is in. For example, entering 1000' will match the feet units that your Project is in, so it
can mean either 1000 International Feet or 1000 US Survey Feet. If your Project is in meters, then the
' symbol is interpreted as International Feet.
Fractional Feet
When entering distances in a fractional format, use a ' symbol or a space between the feet and inches
values to separate them. A " symbol is not required. For example, you can enter 10'6 or 10 6 which
both mean 10'6". You can enter fractional inches by placing a space between the whole and fractional
inches, and using a / symbol in the fraction. For example, 10'6 1/2 or 10 6 1/2 both mean 10'6.5". You
can also enter decimal values, such as 10.5' to mean 10'6" or 10'6.5 (or just 10 6.5) to mean 10'6 ½".
International Feet
You can specify that a distance is in International Feet by entering ”ft” after the value, for example
1000ft means 1000 International Feet.
US Survey Feet
You can specify that a distance is in US Survey Feet by entering ”usft” or ”ftus” after the value, for
example 1000usft and 1000ftus both mean 1000 US Survey Feet.
- 35 -
Stonex FieldGenius
20.117 m
10000m 10000 meters 32808.40'
10000 m
10 6 10 feet 6 inches 10.50'
10'6
10'6"
10 6 1/2 10 feet 6.5 inches 10.54'
10'6 1/2
- 36 -
Getting Started
Math operators are now supported again. You are now permitted to use math operators in distance
fields.
- 37 -
Stonex FieldGenius
NOTE: If your Project is set to feet and you enter 2 3 (2 space 3), this will be interpreted as 2 feet 3
inches. This occurs if your Project is set to either decimal or fractional feet.
You can also use the RPN Calculator to further manipulate distance values. For example, if you want
to find the distance halfway between points 1 and 2, enter 1..2 into the distance field to recall that dis-
tance. Then double tap on that extended edit field to pull that recalled distance into the calculator,
where you can divide the distance by 2 (or perform any other calculations with it). Then press the OK
button in the calculator to copy the result back into the field you started from.
Direction Recall
You can recall the direction between two points, by inputting in the form: FromID..ToID Example:
26..84 will be recognized as the direction computed between points 26 and 84. The direction will be
returned in whichever format your units settings is set to.
Unit Modifiers
You can always override your Project's units setting by entering the bearing with the cardinal quadrant
indicated before or after the direction. If there is no quadrant specified, then the input direction will be
interpreted as an Azimuth.
Decimal Degrees
You can always specify that an angle is in decimal degrees by entering "d" after the value, for
example 45.5083d means 45.5083° or 45°30'30".
Degrees, Decimal Minutes
You can always specify that an angle is in degrees and decimal minutes by entering "dm" after the
value, for example 45.305dm means 45°30.5' or 45°30'30".
- 38 -
Getting Started
- 39 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 40 -
Getting Started
- 41 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 42 -
Main Interface
MAIN INTERFACE
The FieldGenius interface is separated into various toolbars which contain common functions or tools
that the user will use most often.
Display Toolbar
Instrument Toolbar
Topo Toolbar
Mini Toolbar button
Main Menu button
- 43 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Portrait Display
- 44 -
Main Interface
Landscape Display
Toolbars
Display Toolbar
The display toolbar, located at the top of the map screen, is used to zoom, pan, change 3D per-
spectives, and for displaying information.
Next, Previous
These switch to the next or previous set of buttons.
- 45 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Observation
This opens or closes the Observation Toolbar. Many different functions in
FieldGenius will display information in this toolbar, such as when you select a
point on the screen, the point's coordinates are displayed in this toolbar.
Zoom Extents
This is a zoom extents which will zoom to the extents of your Project.
Dynamic Zoom
This is a dynamic zoom. When enabled, drag from top to bottom of the screen to
zoom out, or bottom to top of the screen to zoom in. Or, when enabled, you can
also use the arrow keys on your keypad to zoom in and out in the map.
Zoom Window
This is a zoom window. When enabled, drag on the map screen to define a zoom
window.
Dynamic Pan
This is a dynamic pan. When enabled, you can drag across your map screen to
pan around your Project. Or, when enabled, you can use the toggle or arrow keys
on your keypad to pan around.
Zoom Previous
You can use this to zoom back up to 10 previous views. This includes zoom and
pan changes.
World Button
It is used by the Staking commands to hide unrelated points and lines in your map
during stakeout.
3D View
This opens the 3D View Toolbar.
- 46 -
Main Interface
Layers Manager
This opens the Layers Manager for managing visibility of layers in your database,
DXF Layers, LandXML elements, and Raster Images.
Surface Manager
This opens the Surface Manager for importing and displaying DTM surface models
(TIN, TGRID, or Contours) and for computing Volume Calculations.
Options
This opens the Options screen, and will automatically expand the Map Con-
figuration section for quickly turning on or off the ID, description, and elevation
labels for your points.
Help
This opens the Help topic for the current toolbar(s) visible on your screen. If there
are multiple toolbars visible, you are prompted to select the help file based on the
position of the toolbar: Top, Side, or Bottom Toolbar. The help file will open up in
your default web browser such as Internet Explorer .
Observation Toolbar
Display Toolbar | Observation Results button
l Horizontal Angle (HA), Vertical Angle (ZA), and Slope Distance (SD)
l Horizontal Angle (HA), Horizontal Distance (HD), and Vertical Distance (VD)
l Northing (N), Easting (E), and Elevation (H)
If using a conventional (non-robotic) total station, the observations displayed in the toolbar will be
from the last measurement taken with FieldGenius.
If using a robotic total station, the observations displayed in the toolbar will continually update in real
time.
- 47 -
Stonex FieldGenius
GNSS Observations
GNSS users can toggle through the following information:
If using GNSS, the observations displayed in the toolbar will continually update in real time.
Display Size +/-
By tapping on the + and - buttons on the screen you can increase or decrease the displayed font size/-
text for easier viewing.
Page Toggle
The Page button allows you to swap between pages changing the displayed observation information.
3D View Toolbar
The 3D View toolbar is used to help you view your Project in a 3D perspective. You can also define a
virtual grid that will displayed in the drawing and can be turned on and off.
To turn this feature on select the 3D View button on the Display toolbar. When you do this the 3D
View Toolbar will appear at the bottom of your screen. The buttons on the toolbar are described
below.
3D View
When this is turned on you will be able to rotate your Project in a
3D perspective. This tool is handy when used in conjunction with
surfaces, road alignments, or vertical projections. To return to
plan view, close the 3D View toolbar and press the Zoom
Extents button. It can also help you find points that have incor-
rect elevations.
- 48 -
Main Interface
Center on Point
Use this to center the view on the selected point. This will not
change your current view rotation or zoom depth.
Hz Grid
Use this to turn on a horizontal grid that will be displayed in your
drawing. You can set the grid spacing in the settings.
Vert Grid
Use this when using the Vertical Projection tool to turn on a ver-
tical grid that will be displayed in your drawing. You can set the
grid spacing in the settings.
Planar View
Use this when using the Vertical Projection tool to set the view
perpendicular to the vertical plane, so that the wall or other pro-
jected plane is displayed face-on in the map view.
Grid Settings
Use this to set parameters that affect the grid spacing and origin.
You can select the grid origin using a point chooser and specify
lengths for the sides. You can also specify the interval for each
axis.
- 49 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Auto-Center
This toggles the auto-center feature on or off. If turned on,
whenever you take a measurement, the map screen will always
re-center on the measured point.
Instrument Settings
This opens the Total Station Settings screen where you can con-
trol specific settings for your total station such as EDM settings,
Tolerance setting and Instrument Connect/Disconnect.
Target Manager
Press this button to access the Target Manager. Here you can set
target heights and create, edit, copy, and delete targets.
Measure Mode
This opens the Measure Modes screen where you can select what
type of measurement you want to take. The current Measure Mode
is always displayed on this button - for example if you're using the
distance offset mode it will display "Dist Off".
- 50 -
Main Interface
Measure Button
This triggers your total station to take a measurement.
See also:
Manual mode
This button indicates that the instrument is in manual aiming
mode.
- 51 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 52 -
Main Interface
Target Manager
Opens the Target Manager where you can set the target, target
height and EDM mode.
Measure Mode
Opens the Measure Modes screen where you can select what
type of measurement you want to take. The current Measure
Mode is always displayed on this button - for example if you're
using the distance offset mode it will display "Dist Off".
Measure Button
Measure and store distances and angles. The current state of
Manual / ATR / LOCK mode determines the sequence of events:
If you are using a conventional non-robotic total station, please see the Instrument Toolbar topic.
If you are using GPS, please see the GNSS Toolbar topic.
- 53 -
Stonex FieldGenius
GNSS Toolbar
Once the user has selected a GNSS receiver and communication
has been established, the GNSS toolbar will appear on the main
interface.
NOTE: You will only see the GNSS toolbar if you selected GNSS
Reference, GNSS Rover, or GNSS Rover Demo as your instru-
ment type. If you have selected a GNSS Profile but are not yet con-
nected to the receiver, most of these buttons will be disabled.
Auto-Center
Single-tapping this button will re-center the display on the current
position of your receiver.
Double-tapping this button will set the system into an auto-pan
mode where the display will always be centered on the current pos-
ition. When active, single-tapping this button once more will dis-
able the auto-pan mode.
GNSS Settings
If you press this button while you are connected to a receiver, you
will see the GNSS Settings screen. At any time this button can be
used to adjust or stop your GNSS survey.
If you press this button without being connected to a receiver, you
will see the Instrument Selection screen where you can edit your
GNSS profiles or connect to your receiver.
DOP Values
This displays the current DOP (Dilution of Precision) values.
Pressing this button will cycle through the PDOP, HDOP and
VDOP. The PDOP is the default setting as this is most often used
to ascertain the quality of the satellite geometry.
- 54 -
Main Interface
- 55 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Disto/Laser Toolbar
When FieldGenius is connected to a Disto/Laser device, you will
see this toolbar on the side of the map area. A User Input option
determines which side of the map area the toolbar is on.
This toolbar allows you to control your instrument settings, target
height, device toggles, and Measure Modes, as well as initiating a
measurement.
Auto-Center
This toggles the auto-center feature on or off. If turned on,
whenever you take a measurement, the map screen will always
re-center on the measured point.
Instrument Settings
This opens the instrument settings screen where you can control
specific settings for your Disto/Laser.
Target Manager
Press this button to access the Target Manager. Here you can set
the target height.
Laser Toggle
Press this button to toggle the state of the red laser pointer.
Map Toggle
Press this button to toggle between the map view or live video
stream. NOTE: The live video stream is only available on sup-
ported devices, such as the Leica 3D Disto.
Zoom Controls
- 56 -
Main Interface
Zoom in and out on the live video stream view. NOTE: The live
video stream is only available on supported devices, such as the
Leica 3D Disto.
Crosshair Toggle
Press this button to toggle the crosshair presence on captured
images that are stored.
Photo Note Toggle
Press this button to toggle whether a photo note is automatically
stored when a point is measured and stored. The photo can have a
crosshair showing the measurement point, depending on the
crosshair toggle.
Measure Mode
This opens the Measure Mode screen where you can select what
type of measurement you want to take. The current Measure Mode
is always displayed on this button - for example if you're using the
distance offset mode it will display "Dist Off".
Measure Button
This triggers your device to take a measurement.
See also:
Topo Toolbar
- 57 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The Topo Toolbar is used to help automate linework as well as show you the description and next
point number for your shot. Just like previous versions of FieldGenius you can control your linework
by tuning on and off the line, arc and curvy toggles. There is also a user-programmable button that can
be customized to start any command.
Main Menu Button
This button takes you into the Main Menu.
- 58 -
Main Interface
Next ID Field
This field displays the point number that will be assigned
to your next shot. You can change it at any time prior to
recording your shot. In a new Project this field will always
start at 1. If you open an existing Project, then we scan
the raw file for the last sideshot or store point and if we
find one, we'll set the point number accordingly. For
example, if the last sideshot in the raw file was to point
58, then the next time the Project is setup we will set the
next id to 59.
Active Line List Button
Much like the first line in the Project, just select the
desired description from the list and select the desired
draw option before shooting the first point for the new line.
When you press the button a screen will appear listing all
your active lines. Selecting one of them and pressing the
OK button will make it the current line.
The key to note is the display of -Start Line- in the Active
Lines list. Once the first point for the new line has been
measured, the Active Lines list will set and display the
new line as current.
To change the current line, simply select the desired line
from the Active Lines list and continue taking shots to add
to the selected line. All settings are stored for each line so
there is no need to re-select the Description or draw
option.
Description Selection Button
Use this button to set the current description that will be
used when you shoot your points. When you press the
description button you will see a screen listing all the
descriptions read in from your AutoMap Library. Select
the description you want to use and press the OK button.
You can type in the letters of the description which will
automatically scroll to the descriptions matching your
entry.
- 59 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Mini Toolbar
The mini toolbar control is found directly beneath the Main Menu
button on the Topo Toolbar. It is used to help you maximize your
screen space by allowing you to control which toolbars you need
to keep active in the main interface. When you press the mini tool-
bar control you will see the mini toolbar appear toward the bottom
of the main interface.
Use this to display the full Topo Toolbar.
- 60 -
Main Interface
Note, this toolbar functionality can be enabled or disabled via the Map Position Select check-box in
the Options screen.
Measure Distance
When this is toggled on, subsequent taps will cause the blue dot to move to the new location, a
second blue dot will appear at the previous location, and a dashed line will follow the entire path of the
selected points. The total distance and the direction of the last segment will be displayed. To reset
the measured distance, toggle this mode off then back on again.
Turn to Point
If you are using a motorized total station and have occupied a point in the Project, this will cause your
instrument to turn to the selected point (as indicated by the blue dot in the map).
Store Point
This will open the Store Point dialogue with the coordinates entered for the selected point, so you can
store it into your Project database.
- 61 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Point Labels
In the drawing area you will always see a node or dot that marks the coordinate location of the point.
For each point you can control what is displayed on the screen such as the point's number, elevation,
description and note. To control the visibility of the labels, use the Options button on the Display Tool-
bar.
Point Toolbar
When you tap on an existing point in the drawing you will see the point toolbar appear near the bottom
of your screen. The point toolbar contains functions that are frequently used on points in your Project.
Following is an explanation of what each button will do.
- 62 -
Points & Figures
Points List
This will display the list of all points in your current Project and you
can sort the list by tapping on any of the column headings. When
you find the point you want simply tap it and press the ok button.
Inverse Tool
Use this to measure the inverse between points.
New Point
This will open the store and edit dialog and allow you to enter
coordinates for a new point.
Edit Point
Use this to edit the coordinate value for the selected point.
Delete Point
This will delete the selected point from the drawing and database.
You will be asked to confirm that you want to delete the point.
Offset
This will open the Offset Tool.
Draw Tool
Use this to draw lines, points, and connect line work between
existing points. This will open the Draw Tool.
Zoom to Point
This button when pressed for the first time will force the point to be
centered on the screen. Subsequently, if you keep pressing it, it
will continue to zoom in on the point.
Stake Point
Pressing this will help you stake the point that is currently selec-
ted and take you to the Stake Points screen.
Select Point
Use these two buttons to scroll up and down numerically through
the points in your database.
- 63 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Point ID
This displays the Point ID of the point you've currently selected.
When select it you will see the point chooser toolbar open up towards the bottom of your screen.
Point ID
You can either type the Point ID into this field if you know what it is, or when you tap on a point in the
map screen its point ID will be displayed here.
Quick Select
If Quick Select is turned on, then as soon as you tap on a point in the map screen you will be auto-
matically returned to the routine you were selecting the point for. If Quick Select is turned off, then
after you tap on a point in the map screen, the coordinate data of that point will be displayed, and you
must press the Select button to get back to the previous routine.
Select
Pressing this will take you and your selected point back to the routine you were selecting the point for.
List
Use this to open a grid displaying all the points in your Project database. From this list you can click
on a point and when you press the OK button it will be inserted into the Point ID field.
- 64 -
Points & Figures
New
Use this to open the Store / Edit Points screen. This will enable you to create a new point.
Cancel
Pressing this will take you back to the routine you were selecting the point for, without selecting the
selected Point.
Point Averaging
Main Interface | Edit | Points
Main Interface | Store Points
Main Menu | Survey Tools | View Averaged Points
Main Menu | Data Manager | Point Database
This routine allows the user to either select a number of points from within the Point Database, and
then calculate the average of the coordinate values of the selected points or take repeated meas-
urements on a target and average the coordinate values. You can then create and store a new point
based on the averaged coordinates.
Below is a screen capture taken after an observation has been completed and is awaiting to be
stored. Note that there is a pull down menu for the user to choose to store this measurement as an
averaged point.
- 65 -
Stonex FieldGenius
After the observation has been stored the next screen will prompt you to select the Original Point to
which this point will be averaged too. If this is the first observation then the point should be stored as
a Side Shot to begin the Point Averaging routine.
After two or more observations are stored as an Averaged Point; FieldGenius will display the Stand-
ard Deviation of all the observations included in the Point Averaging. The user can then choose to
Save the temporary observations for future use or Store Averaged to update the Point coordinates
with the result of the Point Averaging observations.
- 66 -
Points & Figures
Observations can be toggled manually by pressing the Green Check Mark to select the best ones for
averaging calculations.
The Weighted Average check box will only be active when using a GNSS unit
Press the "SAVE" button to store all observations in the Averaged Point routine for future use.
Press the "Store Averaged" button to calculate a point position based on all Point Averaged obser-
vations currently being used.
All the temporary shots, observations used for the calculation, and final averaged position are stored
in the raw file.
Point Database
FieldGenius can also calculate the averaged coordinates of multiple stored points directly from the
Point Database.
When you enter the Point Database, tap on the green arrow button twice in the bottom toolbar until
you see the Average button displayed. Note: The items will loop back around to the first item if you
keep pressing the green arrow button.
Select multiple points by tapping on the screen and dragging a box around the items you wish to
include in the averaging calculation.
- 67 -
Stonex FieldGenius
In the Point Averaging dialog, the results of the averaging computation are displayed. You can un-
check the box in the Use column to disable/re-enable a selected point.
Press the Average button when finished. This takes you to the Point Averaging dialog.
The Store Point button takes you to the Store Point dialog.
The Cancel button returns you to Point Database dialog.
- 68 -
Points & Figures
FieldGenius also allows the user to select the Original Point from the Point Database and by pressing
the "Edit" button there is a new button in the Edit Point screen that displays all the current Point Aver-
aging observations assigned to the Original Point. So you can continue to add shots to it or if satisfied
store a new averaged point location.
Partition Lines/Arcs
Line Toolbar | Partition button
- 69 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Equal Partitions
You can partition the segment by equal divisions. Simply select the partition number and press the
Partition button. This will compute new points and split the object up into separate segments.
By Distance
You can partition the segment by specifying a distance between partitions. Simply define the partition
distance, then press the Partition button. This will compute new points and split the object up into sep-
arate segments.
AutoMap Library
Main Menu | Settings | AutoMap Library
The AutoMap Library editor allows the user complete control over the visibility of points and lines
based on the descriptions used to code the points. It also allows you to set attributes for the descrip-
tions such as point and line colour.
- 70 -
Points & Figures
Enter Description
Use this field to auto scroll to description in your list. For example, typing the letters AS will scroll
down to the ASPHCURB description. If you type a unique description and press enter, you will be
prompted for whether you want to add it into the AutoMap Library or not.
Show descriptions in use only
Use this to display only the descriptions found in your AutoMap Library that are used in the current
Project.
Adding Descriptions to the Library in FieldGenius
While you're working you can add descriptions to the AutoMap Library on the fly. When you enter a
description that isn't in the library you will be prompted with a message asking you if you want to add
it to your Project's AutoMap Library file.
Note: This prompt can be turned off so FieldGenius always uses the new descriptions without adding
them into the AutoMap Library file. To do this you need to make sure you have the "Prompt New
Descriptions" toggle turned off in the Options menu.
If you answer Yes, then the description will be added into the Project's AutoMap Library file (not to the
AutoMap Template file).
If you answer No, then the description will be used without adding it into the AutoMap Library. If you
do not add it to the AutoMap Library, then you will not be able to set options such as defining the layer
and colour of points and lines with this description.
- 71 -
Stonex FieldGenius
These properties are stored in the library in specific columns. Please refer to the topic below about
editing the library for more information.
Summary
You can use this field to summarize your description. For example, a description IP may have a sum-
mary Iron Pin.
Point Symbol
You can define a marker for a point. These markers are not automatically transferred back to the
desktop and are not similar to CAD blocks or parts. They are simply point nodes that will be displayed
in the map view to help distinguish different points on the screen. There are 27 different marker types.
The symbol for each description is also shown on the AutoMap Library screen.
Point Size
This allows you to change the size of the marker. You will find that using a number of 1 is a good start-
ing point. Adjust from there as needed.
Point Colour
This allows you to set the colour of the markers. You can choose from a list of 255 colours.
- 72 -
Points & Figures
Line Colour
This allows you to change the colour of lines in your drawing.
Layer Name
This specifies the layer that will be used for lines and points with this description.
Connect Points With Line
If this is checked, when you select the description from the topo toolbar on the main display, the con-
nect lines toggle will be turned on automatically. Use this for descriptions that typically are connected
by lines such as an edge of road or ditch center line.
Do not assign to DTM
This is very useful for the creation of real-time surface models. If you toggle this ON, then these
points will not be included in any DTM created with FieldGenius. Use this for descriptions that are not
at ground level.
Deleting Descriptions from the Library from FieldGenius
The AutoMap Editor allows you to delete descriptions from the library. Pressing the Delete button will
prompt you to make sure that you want to delete the selected entry. This will delete that entry from
the Project's AutoMap Library file, it does not affect the AutoMap Template file.
Editing an Existing Library outside of FieldGenius
The AutoMap Library is a very powerful feature in FieldGenius. When combined with our desktop
products, your downloaded files can literally be imported, layers and symbols placed in seconds. For
this topic we will concentrate on helping you work with and edit the AutoMap library using
FieldGenius.
The FieldGenius AutoMap library is a comma delimited file that can be edited with Stonex Geomatics
CAD, with a text editor like Microsoft Notepad, or with a spreadsheet application like Microsoft Excel.
Since not every FieldGenius user owns our desktop software we will discuss editing the file with
Excel.
The first row in the file is reserved for the column header. Some of the columns are reserved for our
desktop products, but the following columns are used in FieldGenius.
Column A = Description (String value)
Column B = Summary of Description (String value)
Column L = Connect Points with Line (1=Yes, 0=No)
Column M = Layer Name (String value)
Column O = Line Colour (Number 0-255)
Column Q = Line or Spline (0=Spline, 1=Line) *** This works in conjunction with Column L.
- 73 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Feature List
A feature list is a tool built into FieldGenius so you can collect attribute data for your points. Feature
files allow you to define what data needs to be collected about a point's attributes. You can define
mandatory fields, default values, true/false items and select from list options. First you need to create
a feature list file using the Feature List Editor which can be installed from your FieldGenius CD.
Please refer to the help menu in the editor for more information on how to create an effective feature
file.
Feature files have a FEA extension and they should be copied to your ...\Stonex\FieldGenius\FG
Projects\ (Windows CE/Mobile) or ...\Documents\Stonex\FieldGenius\FG Projects\ (Windows
Tablet/PC) directory. There is no limitation to the number of feature files that can be stored on your
data collector. Once you have created your file and copied it to the appropriate directory, you can set
it at the Review Files Screen.
In this example we will open a Feature List File named Sample.fea.
- 74 -
Points & Figures
To collect attribute data for a point, you have to press the GIS Attributes button on the store and edit
dialog.
When you store a point during a measurement or edit one afterwards, you will see that you can select
the GIS Attributes button. When you press this button, it will look at the point's description and
check to see if you have a feature defined that matches. If it does, it will open up that feature for you
automatically, in our example you will see that the Power Pole feature was opened.
- 75 -
Stonex FieldGenius
As you can see, feature files help you collect consistent and accurate notes about a point you meas-
ured.
When you store the point, a file will be created in the Project directory. The file will have the same
name as the feature and will have a DBF extension. In our example, the file would be named POWER
POLE.DBF. Each point will be appended to the same database file.
The DBF database file can be opened with Microsoft Excel.
Notes
Use this to enter or record audio notes for your points. You can access the notes screen by pressing
the Notes button on the Store / Edit Points screen.
- 76 -
Points & Figures
Text Notes
You can type a note up to 32 characters in length and it will be stored in the Project's DBF file. You
cannot enter more than this limit into the Note field.
When the file is imported into Stonex Geomatics CAD, the note will appear in its own field, or can be
appended to the point's description field.
Continue using this note: Use this if you want to use the note you just entered automatically for
future points that are stored.
Text notes can be written to the raw file as comments when the Option is enabled.
Audio Notes
Use this function to record and playback audio notes that are related to stored points. These notes
will be transferred to Stonex Geomatics CAD desktop software for playback in the office.
The notes will be stored in your Project directory and will be automatically named for you. Example, if
you recorded a note for point 2, a file would be created pnt2.wav. The file that is created is a standard
windows WAV file that can be played by most audio players.
Stonex Geomatics CAD desktop software will automatically link to any audio note you recorded. This
allows you to easily see which points have audio notes.
Recording and Playback Controls
Circle = record
Square = stop
- 77 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Triangle = playback
Trash = delete
Note that not all handheld devices support audio notes. You must have a record and playback func-
tionality, which for some units requires optional accessories.
To Store an Audio Note:
1. Tap the red circle to activate recording. Speak into your microphone to record the desired
information. "This post is bent" etc.
2. Press the square button to stop the recording
3. To confirm your note, press the playback arrow, now green on color displays, and listen to your
note
1. Delete the existing audio note. You will be prompted to confirm the deletion.
2. Record a new audio note.
- 78 -
Points & Figures
In the example shown, notice E/ASPH:1 on the button. This is the current Active Line. E/ASPH is the
point description and 1 is the group number (added automatically). Since this is the first figure in the
map, it is assigned group 1.
- 79 -
Stonex FieldGenius
A Figure is a continuous series of Line, Curve and/or Arc segments. The Figure is identified by Point
Description and a group number. Whenever a new line is started, a new Figure is created and added
to the Active Lines list with an automatically assigned group number. The group number will incre-
ment by one when a previously used point description is used for a subsequent line. (Notice there are
two E/ASPH lines in the example)
Furthermore, all linework in FieldGenius is handled in 3D.
When you press the E/ASPH:2 Active Line button you will see a list of the figures in your Project.
- 80 -
Points & Figures
Figures
Tangents, arcs and curvy lines in FieldGenius are also called figures. Figures are created auto-
matically for you as soon as you connect points in the drawing.
Figures can be created while you survey in real-time using our active linework or you can manually
create the figure using the pencil tool.
FieldGenius Figures
When you click on a figure the Line Toolbar will appear. You will also see bold text in the drawing area
indicating what you selected.
DXF Linework
When you import a DXF drawing you will see all the linework that exists in the drawing. When you
select a DXF line or arc you will see the Line Toolbar but everything will be greyed out except for the
stake and perpendicular distance buttons. If you press the stake button or perpendicular offset to
point button, they will open up their respective toolbars.
When you click on a DXF entity you will see bold text in the drawing area indicating that you picked a
DXF line or arc, and it will display which layer it is on.
You can control the visibility of DXF layers through the Layers Manager screen.
- 81 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Line Toolbar
When you tap on an existing line or arc you will see the line toolbar appear near the bottom of your
screen. The line toolbar contains functions that are frequently used on line or arcs in your Project. Fol-
lowing is an explanation of what each button will do.
Set Figure Current
Use this to make the current line or arc current in the Active Line
List.
- 82 -
Points & Figures
End Figure
Use this to mark a line as complete or finished.
Close Figure
Use this to close a figure so it finishes at the same point it started
at.
Open Figure List
Use this to display the Active Line List.
Draw Tool
Use this to draw lines, points, and connect line work between exist-
ing points. This will open the Draw Tool.
Convert Line to Spline
This will turn an existing figure that is comprised of straight lines
into a curvy line, and vice-versa.
Offset Tool
Use this to open the Offset Tool.
Stake Figure
Use this to open the stake line command and stake the current line
you have selected.
- 83 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Whichever Selection Mode you use, the selected line will be highlighted in red in the map screen
along with a direction indicator. If necessary, you can press the Switch Direction button to reverse
the start and end of the selected line. Press OK to accept the selected line and proceed to the next
step.
Selection Mode: Figure/DXF
Pick this mode to select an existing figure or DXF entity by selecting the desired figure from the map
screen. You can select any of the following:
- 84 -
Points & Figures
Please Note: A line or arc segment from a DXF polyline cannot be selected.
Selection Mode: Define Points
Pick this mode to select points in your Project to define a line or arc. You can define the following line
types:
Switch Direction
The line direction will reverse, and the arrowhead shown in the map screen will show the current "for-
ward" direction of the line.
OK
The highlighted line will be selected, and you will be returned to the appropriate command.
Cancel
You will return to the previous screen without selecting anything.
Figure List
The figure list contains a listing of all figures in your Project.
- 85 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Line Column
This is the group id assigned to the figure. Refer to the Active Linework topic for more information.
Active Column
If the figure is active, you will see the word YES. To make a figure not active, press the Switch Active
State button.
Description Column
This is the name of your figure which will usually match the description of the first point that the figure
is connected to.
Points Column
This is the total number of points that the figure is connected to.
Closed Column
If you closed the figure you will see the word Yes.
Show Active Figures
When this is selected (default setting) all of your active figures will be listed. You can select a figure
that you would like to work on simply by selecting it in the list and pressing the OK button. If this is
turned off, then all the figures in the Project will be displayed.
- 86 -
Points & Figures
Draw Curvy Lines button = Connect Points with a best-fit curvy line.
Draw 3-Point Arc button = Fit an arc through three measured points
- 87 -
Stonex FieldGenius
After the measurement to the first point for the new line is complete, the line will be added to the Act-
ive Lines list, identified by the current point description and an automatically assigned group number:
E/ASPH:3. The group number is three, because this is the third figure using the description E/ASPH.
- 88 -
Points & Figures
After the second point for this line has been recorded, the first segment will be created. From this
point forward, simply continue taking shots to add to the now current Active Line: E/ASPH:3
Note the insertion of ":3", this is the group number. Re-use of the Description E/ASPH for a new line
series in the current Project will automatically increment the group number by one. This allows you
track and store multiple active lines of the same description without the need for multiple entries in
your AutoMap Library. For example, E/ASPH:2, E/ASPH:3 ... E/ASPH:n can now be replaced with a
single E/ASPH entry.
- 89 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 90 -
Points & Figures
Once you select the figure, you will see the line toolbar. On this toolbar, select this
button to reverse the direction. After you switch the direction, you will see the blue
"X" move to the opposite end of the figure.
New Figure
Pre-selection of Line Descriptions
A list of Active Lines (Figures) may be pre-specified to aid in planning for a complicated Project. Use
the New Figure button on the Active Line List screen to specify a Line Description before taking any
shots.
- 91 -
Stonex FieldGenius
You have the opportunity to use a manually entered comment with this method but the new line will be
linked to the selected Line Description. The comment will appear in the Active Lines list to aid correct
selection of the line.
- 92 -
Points & Figures
To change the current line, simply select the active line button which will open the Select Figure from
List screen. In this example it is the E/ASPH:3 button.
Select the desired figure from the list and continue taking shots to add to the selected line. All settings
are stored for each line so there is no need to reselect the Description or draw option.
- 93 -
Stonex FieldGenius
3-Point Arcs
To draw a three point arc on an ongoing Line, select the Draw 3-Point Arc button before shooting the
second of the three points that will define the arc (POC). (Note that this is not the radius point). After
measuring to the 2nd point, a dashed line will appear to illustrate that a 3-Point arc is in progress.
Shoot the 3rd point and the arc will appear. The current draw option will change from Draw 3-Pt Arc to
Draw Line after the third observation and the arc is complete.
We are going to connect a three point arc to the E/ASPH figure. Since we are meas-
uring the midpoint of the arc, you need to turn on the three point arc toggle.
After you complete the measurement, you will see the midpoint drawn on the screen.
- 94 -
Points & Figures
Once you complete the third measurement, you will see the arc drawn in the map.
- 95 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Any Active Line series (figure) can be changed from a series of straight segments to a best-fit curvy
line. Select the figure in the drawing to open the line toolbar. On the toolbar press the Line-Spline but-
ton which will convert the line to a curvy line. If the line is already a curvy line, it will convert it to
straight tangents between the points.
Note that any 3 point arcs or straight line segments will be lost when you use this function.
Complex Figure
Figures that contain straight segments, arcs and spline segments are said to be a complex figure.
- 96 -
Points & Figures
Closing Figures
To make a closed figure with an Active Line, select the Close Current Line button
on the line toolbar. This will draw a line from the last point to the first point shot in
the figure. The Line will be removed from the Active Lines list as it is now con-
sidered complete.
You will see that the figure now is closed back to the original start point.
In the active lines list, if you turn off the Show Active Figures you will see that the figure is flagged
as Active = NO and Closed = YES.
- 97 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Alternatively, you can also close a figure in the Figure List screen by using the Close Figure button.
To mark a line as complete or finished, use the End Current Line button on the line toolbar. This will
remove the line from the Active Lines list so that no more segments or arcs can be added.
This works similar to closing a figure, but differs in that the figure will not be forced to close back on to
the original start point.
Re-Activating Figures
When a figure has been marked as complete, you can activate it again as follows:
From the Line Toolbar
You can visually pick on the map view the figure that you would like to re-activate.
On the line toolbar, select the activate button which will make the selected figure
active.
- 98 -
Points & Figures
- 99 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Deleting Figures
To delete linework in your Project simply select the figure you want to delete. When you select the fig-
ure, the line toolbar will open.
Use this button on the line toolbar to delete an individual segment
between two points or a three point arc.
Use this to delete the entire figure that you have selected.
Notes:
Splines: Spline sections are considered to be one entity so using the delete entire fig-
ure, or delete segment, each will do the same thing. The entire spline will be deleted.
If a segment or arc is deleted from the middle of a figure, the figure will be broken into
two pieces. Each new figure will be assigned a new group number. Closed or ended
figures will be re-activated and added to the Active Lines list.
You can also delete a figure by selecting it in the active lines list, then pressing the Delete Figure but-
ton.
- 100 -
Points & Figures
In FieldGenius when the description is selected, the line toggle will be automatically turned on.
As shown below, the line toggle has been automatically turned on when the E/ASPH description was
selected from the list.
Curvy Lines
Choose the following to set the draw default for FieldGenius to Curvy Lines
- 101 -
Stonex FieldGenius
In FieldGenius when the description is selected, the curvy toggle will be automatically turned on.
As shown below, the curvy toggle has been automatically turned on when the E/ASPH description
was selected from the list.
None
Choose the following to set the draw default for FieldGenius to None
- 102 -
Points & Figures
As shown below, when the HUB description was selected, all line connectivity toggles are turned off.
Notes:
The 2D Connection and 3D Connection settings do not affect FieldGenius, we only
make use of these settings as defaults in Stonex Geomatics CAD. All FieldGenius fig-
ures are 3D. With FieldGenius data imported to Stonex Geomatics CAD, there is no
need to process AutoMap connections as FieldGenius figures are drawn auto-
matically. For more details on the AutoMap Library, see your Stonex Geomatics CAD
Help System.
Drawing Tool
Main Menu | Survey Tools | Drawing Tool
Line Toolbar | Pencil button
Point Toolbar | Pencil button
This tool allows you to quickly draw a plan such as a pad or a building footprint into your Project, and
is typically used to recreate plans from a paper hard-copy. You can use this to either calculate new
points, or to connect existing points that are already in your Project.
You must have at least one point in your Project before you can start, to define the starting position for
your plan. If a point does not yet exist (for example if this is the first command you run in a new Pro-
ject), you will be prompted to store a new point before you can proceed.
Line Mode
Use the Line draw mode to add straight line segments to your figure.
- 103 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Start Point
Specify the start point for the new segment.
For starting a new plan, this should be set to an existing point in your Project, typically a corner that
you will begin drawing the plan from.
As you continue adding subsequent points/segments to your plan, you will see the Start Point field
automatically advance for you.
Distance
Specify the length of the line segment you wish to draw.
Direction
Specify the direction (Azimuth or Bearing) of the line segment you wish to draw. The easiest way to
do this is to use the right/left arrow buttons, which will increment/decrement the direction value by the
amount shown in the pulldown list below the arrows. You can select a common angle from the
choices in the list (90, 45, or 30 degrees), or you can type any value if you need to increment it by
some other amount.
Store
After you have defined the segment to add, press this to store the new point and line segment into
your Project.
- 104 -
Points & Figures
Store+
This does the same as the Store button, but you will see the Store/Edit Point screen. Use this to con-
firm or view the coordinates, or to specify a description.
Point by Line Mode
This is the same as the Line mode, except that when you press Store or Store+ it will only store the
point, without drawing the line segment.
Arc Mode
Use the Arc draw mode to add arc segments to your figure.
Start Point
Specify the start point for the new segment.
For starting a new plan, this should be set to an existing point in your Project, typically a corner that
you will begin drawing the plan from.
As you continue adding subsequent points/segments to your plan, you will see the Start Point field
automatically advance for you.
Direction
Specify the direction (Azimuth or Bearing) of the tangent in to the arc segment you wish to draw.
This will default to either the direction of the previous line segment or the tangent out of the previous
arc segment, so as long as your arc is tangential to the previous segment you will not need to change
this value.
- 105 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Radius
Specify the radius to define your arc.
Clockwise / Counter-Clockwise Arrows
Use the Right/Left arrow buttons to define whether the arc rotates clockwise or counter-clockwise.
Store
After you have defined the segment to add, press this to store the new end and radial points, and draw
the arc segment into your Project.
Store+
This does the same as the Store button, but you will see the Store/Edit Point screen. Use this to con-
firm or view the coordinates, or to specify a description.
Point by Arc Mode
This is the same as the Arc mode, except that when you press Store or Store+ it will only store the
points, without drawing the arc segment.
Connect Points Mode
This mode lets you draw lines/arcs by connecting points that already exist in your Project.
- 106 -
Points & Figures
Start Point
Specify the start point for the new segment.
For starting a new plan, this should be set to an existing point in your Project, typically a corner that
you will begin drawing the plan from.
As you continue connecting subsequent points to your plan, you will see the Start Point field auto-
matically advance for you.
Line Type
Specify one of the five available methods to define your next figure segment:
l Straight: this will draw a straight line between the specified Start Point and End Point.
l Arc (CW): this will draw a clockwise arc between the specified Start Point and End Point, with
the specified Radial Point.
l Arc (CCW): this will draw a counter-clockwise arc between the specified Start Point and End
Point, with the specified Radial Point.
l Arc (3Pnt): this will draw an arc (clockwise or counter-clockwise) between the specified Start
Point and End Point, going through the specified intermediate Arc Point (any point directly on
the arc, does not need to be the midpoint).
l Spline: this will draw a curvy line between the specified Start Point and End Point.
- 107 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Store / Store+
The Store and Store+ buttons are disabled for this mode, because new points are not being calculated
for your Project. The line or arc segment will be automatically drawn into your Project after you spe-
cify its parameters.
Undo
Press the Undo button to undo the last segment you computed, removing both the point and/or the
line segment (as appropriate) from your Project. You can undo multiple steps.
Note, there is no Redo function.
Close
Press the Close button to exit from the Draw Plan command, and you will be returned to the map
screen.
Smart Tags
When you select an existing or create a figure in your drawing you will see smart tags appear on the
points that make up the figure.
Smart Tag "T"
The T smart tag define points connected to straight line segments.
- 108 -
Points & Figures
- 109 -
Stonex FieldGenius
MAIN MENU
On the main interface of FieldGenius you will see the FieldGenius Start icon which will always activ-
ate the main menu or display the previously viewed sub-menu. When the button is pressed you will
see the main menu screen:
On the main menu, pressing any of the buttons will take you to its sub-menu.
From any sub-menu, pressing the Menu Home button will return you to this menu.
The Map View button will close the main menu and take you back to the map view.
The Exit button will close FieldGenius.
Project Manager
Selecting this will allow you to create, open or delete Project. Please see the Project Manager topic
for more information.
Settings
Select this to check or change settings for FieldGenius. Please see the Settings topic for more inform-
ation.
- 110 -
Main Menu
Measure Modes
Select this to choose a Measure Mode such as occupying a point, checking a point, or measuring an
offset. Please see the Measure Modes topics for more information.
Survey Tools
Select this to execute tools such as manually storing new points, deleting/undoing the previously
measured point, or viewing the raw file. Please see the Survey Tools topic for more information.
Calculations
Select this to use our calculating functions such as COGO and inversing. Please see the Cal-
culations topic for more information.
Staking
Select this to access our staking functions. Please see the Staking topic for more information.
Import/Export
Select this to import or export ASCII files, and to export DXF, XML, and other files. Please see the
Import/Export topic for more information.
Please note, additional file types can be imported from the Surface Manager and the Map Data Layers
Manager, both located in the Data Manager menu.
Data Manager
Use this to manage your points, DXF files, and surfaces. Please see the Data Manager topic for more
information.
Roads Manager
Use this to access tools that will help you create or edit alignments, templates, and profiles. Please
see the Roads Manager topic for more information.
- 111 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Project Manager
Main Menu | Project Manager
The Project Manager is used to create, open, or delete Projects stored on your data collector. When
you start FieldGenius this is always the first screen you will see.
You can sort the list by Project name or date by tapping on the column's header.
FG Projects Folder
Press this button to specify a different Project folder than the default. The default is
...\Stonex\FieldGenius\FG Projects\ (Windows CE/Mobile) or ...\Docu-
ments\Stonex\FieldGenius\FG Projects\ (Windows Tablet/PC). Once you set the directory it is writ-
ten to the MSurvey.ini file and is used for all subsequent Projects.
Delete Project
To delete a Project, pick the Delete trash can icon next to the Project Name. You will be asked to con-
firm that you really want to delete the Project.
Notes:
- You cannot delete a Project that is currently open
- Projects that have been deleted cannot be restored
Open Project
To open an existing Project, simply select it in the list and press the Open button.
- 112 -
Main Menu
- 113 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Settings Menu
Main Menu | Settings
The settings menu is used to setup and review settings that have been set for your current Project.
You can also specify default settings for new Projects that are created.
Most of these settings are stored in a file named MSurvey.ini which can be found in the
...\Stonex\FieldGenius\Programs\ (Windows CE/Mobile) or ...\Pro-
gramData\Stonex\FieldGenius\9\ (Windows Tablet/PC) directory. It is recommended that once you
have defined your settings, that you make a backup of this MSurvey.ini file.
Options
Use this to set or change settings that affect FieldGenius's functionality. Please see the Options
topic for more information.
Units and Scale
Use this to set or change the units, bearings, distances and scale settings for your Project. Please
see the Units and Scale topic for more information.
Coordinate System
Use this to define the coordinate system for your Project. Please see the Coordinate System Set-
tings topic for more information.
- 114 -
Main Menu
Keyboard Shortcuts
Use this to define shortcuts to FieldGenius commands and assign them to your keys. Please see the
Keyboard Shortcuts topic for more information.
Language Selection
Pick the Language for the program interface. Many options are available, see the Language Selection
topic for more details.
AutoMap Library
The AutoMap Library editor, see the AutoMap Library topic for more details.
GroupCode Editor
The GroupCode editor, see the GroupCode Editor topic for more details.
Feature List Editor
Launch the external Feature List Editor (Windows Tablet/PC only). See the Feature List Editor topic
for more information.
Project Information
Use this to enter and save information about your Project. Please see the Project Information topic for
more information.
About
Opens the About screen.
Options
Main Menu | Settings | Options
The options screen helps you set settings that affect the look and feel of FieldGenius.
- 115 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Press the [+] buttons along the left to expand (show) each section, and the [-] buttons to collapse
(hide) it.
l Interface Options
l User Input Options
l Point Attributes Options
l Map Configurations Options
l Default Units Options
l Total Station Options
l GNSS Options
l Staking Options
l Roading Options
l System Options
Interface Options
Map Colour
Use this to force the background color for the main drawing area to be white or black
- 116 -
Main Menu
Map Orientation
Using this will force the map screen to be oriented to the north or south. This is needed for coordinate
systems that are referenced south, such as in South Africa. This is different from South Azimuth dir-
ections, as used in Hawaii.
Arc Resolution
This option determines the number of segments that will displayed in an arc on the screen. Reducing
this number increases program speed; increasing this number slows down graphics display, but
improves the quality of arcs and curvy lines displayed on the screen.
Text Size (Info/Grid)
Use this to force the text shown in the Information screens (such as the Observation toolbar and the
COGO History screen) and grid screens (such as the Project Manager and Angle Offset shots) to use
a small or large sized text.
Show Scale Bar
Use this to turn the scale bar shown on the main map screen on or off.
Scrollbar Width
Use this to increase the width of the scroll bar on the map screen.
User Input Options
Keypad Text Color
Use this to turn change the keypad text color to show up better against the keypad background color.
Keypad Background Color
Use this to turn change the keypad background color so the text shows up better.
Extended Edit Boxes
Use this to control how you want to bring up the selected keypad when tapping in an edit box: either
with a single tap, a double tap, or off. Users of devices with a keyboard should leave this set to
Double Click, and users of devices without a keyboard should set this to Single Click. Setting this to
Off disables both the keypad and any other commands that may be started directly from the edit field,
such as the Point Chooser or Inverse Tool, so that edit fields can only be used for typing values from
your physical keypad.
Menu Shortcuts
This will enable menu shortcuts so if you have a keyboard device you can press letter and number
keys to navigate around the program.
- 117 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Instrument Toolbar
You can define if the instrument toolbar is located on either the Right or Left Side of your map screen.
SIP Type
Use this to specify which SIP keypad type you want to use on a Windows Mobile device.
Point Attributes Options
Coordinate Order
Use this to control the display of coordinate values in FieldGenius. Options are NEH, ENH, XYZ,
XYZ (South) and YXZ (South) affecting any area of the program where coordinates are displayed.
This option also affects whether the ASCII Import and ASCII Export commands use a N,E or E,N
(X,Y) file format.
Alphanumeric IDs
When this is enabled you will be allowed to enter Alphanumeric Point IDs such as 21a, AB3, EV2. If
this isn't turned on, then FieldGenius will not accept anything but integer numbers. Alphanumeric
input of Point IDs can contain up to 31 characters.
Alphanumeric Case Sensitive
When this is enabled the Point ID that is used as a unique identifier will be case sensitive, points a1
and A1 will be recorded as 2 separate points.
Notes:
The Case Sensitive setting is applied when the user stores a measured, calculated,
or manually entered point and FieldGenius needs to determine if the Point ID already
exists. In other cases the setting is not used, specifically:
- Importing Points: When importing points the setting will not be applied.
FieldGenius will treat the Point IDs as Case Sensitive, regardless of what the setting
is.
- Point Ranges: Point ranges will be handled as Not Case Sensitive.
- Sorting Points: The Point Database and other sorting applications will always sort
as Not Case Sensitive.
- Point Query: Specifying a Point ID as input will always require an exact match and
is Case Sensitive.
- 118 -
Main Menu
- 119 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Map Configurations
Show ID
This is used to show or hide the point number labels for your points.
Show Description
This is used to show or hide the point description labels for your points.
Show Elevation
This is used to show or hide the point elevation labels for your points.
Level of Detail
The Level of Detail filter, when turned off, will force FieldGenius to show the point labels all the time,
independent of your zoom level. If it is turned on, FieldGenius uses an algorithm to determine if dis-
playing the point labels is necessary.
This is demonstrated in the following two images, the first has LOD turned on and the second has
LOD turned off.
With LOD on, as soon as you zoom in to a reasonable level, the labels will appear automatically.
Under normal circumstances you will keep the LOD feature active.
- 120 -
Main Menu
- 121 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 122 -
Main Menu
Staking Options
Note: You can also access these options directly from the staking toolbar.
Tolerance
This is the error tolerance that the staking command will use. When your staking "move by" distances
are equal to or less than this amount, your direction to a point will be indicated in green text in the
Observation Toolbar at the top left hand corner of the screen. Green text will be displayed to notify
you that you're meeting your tolerance; if you do not meet the tolerance, the text will switch to red.
Orientation Total Station
The user can set an orientation preference for a Total Station layout. Depending on the equipment cur-
rently in use, FieldGenius will automatically use the defined orientation.
Orientation North (Cardinal)
With the North orientation, North is the reference direction. The "move by" distances are standard car-
dinal directions.
North: This is the distance you need to move North.
South: This is the distance you need to move South.
East: This is the distance you need to move East.
West: This is the distance you need to move West.
Cut: This is the amount you have to go down from the current rod position to the stake point's
elevation.
Fill: This is the amount you have to go up from the current rod position to the stake point's elev-
ation.
Orientation North (Directional)
With the North orientation, North is the reference direction. The "move by" distances are indicated by
arows showing the direction of the movement.
Up arrow: This is the distance you need to move North.
Down arrow: This is the distance you need to move South.
Right Arrow: This is the distance you need to move East.
Left Arrow: This is the distance you need to move West.
Cut: This is the amount you have to go down from the current rod position to the stake point's
elevation.
Fill: This is the amount you have to go up from the current rod position to the stake point's elev-
ation.
Instrument
- 123 -
Stonex FieldGenius
With the staking reference set to Instrument the map view will be twisted so the instrument is
centered towards the top of your screen. The "move by" distances are with respect to the rod position
looking towards the instrument. This view is useful when using a robotic instrument.
In: This is the distance you need to move towards the instrument.
Out: This is the distance you need to move away from the instrument.
Right: Facing the instrument, move right by this amount.
Left: Facing the instrument, move left by this amount.
Cut: This is the amount you have to go down from the current rod position to the stake point's
elevation.
Fill: This is the amount you have to go up from the current rod position to the stake point's elev-
ation.
Prism
With the staking reference set to Prism the map view will be twisted so the prism is centered towards
the top of your screen. The "move by" distances are with respect to the instrument man looking at the
prism. This view is handy when using a non-robotic instrument.
In: This is the distance you need to move towards the instrument.
Out: This is the distance you need to move away from the instrument.
Right: Facing the prism, move right by this amount.
Left: Facing the prism, move left by this amount.
Cut: This is the amount you have to go down from the current rod position to the stake point's
elevation.
Fill: This is the amount you have to go up from the current rod position to the stake point's elev-
ation.
User Point
With the User Point orientation, you can use an existing point in your Project as the reference. The
view will be twisted so that the selected point is centered towards the top of your screen.
In: This is the distance you need to move towards your user reference point.
Out: This is the distance you need to move away from your user reference point.
Right: Facing your user reference point, move right by this amount.
Left: Facing your user reference point, move left by this amount.
Cut: This is the amount you have to go down from the current rod position to the stake point's
elevation.
- 124 -
Main Menu
Fill: This is the amount you have to go up from the current rod position to the stake point's elev-
ation.
Line
With the staking reference set to Line the map view will be twisted so the line is drawn vertically with
the start of the line at the bottom of the screen and the end of the line at the top of the screen. The
"move by" distances are with respect to the line.
In: You will not be given an In distance.
Out: You will not be given an Out distance.
Right: Looking down the line (or parallel to it), move right by this amount perpendicularly
towards the line.
Left: Looking down the line (or parallel to it), move left by this amount perpendicularly towards
the line.
Cut: This is the amount you have to go down from the current rod position to the stake line's
interpolated elevation.
Fill: This is the amount you have to go up from the current rod position to the stake line's inter-
polated elevation.
Orientation GNSS
The user can set an orientation preference for a GNSS layout. Depending on the equipment currently
in use, FieldGenius will automatically use the defined orientation.
Orientation North (Cardinal)
With the North orientation, North is the reference direction. The "move by" distances are standard car-
dinal directions.
North: This is the distance you need to move North.
South: This is the distance you need to move South.
East: This is the distance you need to move East.
West: This is the distance you need to move West.
Cut: This is the amount you have to go down from the current rod position to the stake point's
elevation.
Fill: This is the amount you have to go up from the current rod position to the stake point's elev-
ation.
Orientation North (Directional)
With the North orientation, North is the reference direction. The "move by" distances are indicated by
arows showing the direction of the movement.
Up arrow: This is the distance you need to move North.
- 125 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 126 -
Main Menu
Fill: This is the amount you have to go up from the current rod position to the stake line's inter-
polated elevation.
Compass Switch Threshold
This allows a user to input a distance within which the compass on a Total Station.
Attached User ID
Use this to add a value to the point number you’re currently staking. For example if the point you're
staking is point 8, and this field is set to 1000. In the raw file it will show that you staked point 1008
and will also store the staked position as point 1008 in the Project database.
Line Mode
Use this to control how your navigation distances are computed and displayed when staking a Line.
In Auto mode, FieldGenius will automatically determine if it should display in/out or left/right offsets to
the line. Auto mode will display in/out distances if the line of sight intersects the line equal or greater
than 45° (In/Out); if it is less than 45° then FieldGenius will display (Left/Right) offsets to the line.
You can force FieldGenius to always display In/Out distances to the line by setting it to In/Out.
Use Left/Right to always see the Left/Right offset to the line.
If you're staking an arc, FieldGenius will always display in/out offsets no matter what line mode set-
ting FieldGenius is set to.
This option has no effect if you have selected the "Line" Orientation Reference option.
Robotic Prism Tracking
When selected the robotic total station will track the prism as the user moves it across the scene site.
Turn Instrument Mode
If you have a motorized instrument, including robotics, you can control how FieldGenius turns the
instrument during stakeouts. If you want FieldGenius to compute the horizontal and vertical angle
needed to stake your point, use the 3D (HA + VA) option. If all you want is the horizontal angle to be
turned, and the vertical left alone, select the 2D (HA) option.
Cut and Fill Slopes
Use this to specify your cut and fill slopes when you’re slope staking. The fill slope value will be used
when the hinge point is higher than the calculated catch point and this will occur in areas that require a
fill. The cut slope will be used when the hinge point falls below the calculated catch point. This will
occur in areas that require a cut.
A Cut of 2:1 means you would have a cut of 1 unit for every 2 units traveled horizontally.
- 127 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 128 -
Main Menu
Force Tangential
Place a check mark in this box if you would like to automatically enforce the direction of alignment
geometry elements so they remain tangential to previous geometry elements. This rule can be useful
to ensure the alignment geometry elements maintain a common tangent direction between adjacent
elements.
Dynamic Horizontal Alignment
Place a check mark in this box if you would like changes to the direction of alignment geometry ele-
ments to be applied to subsequent geometry elements. To illustrate: modify the direction of a line geo-
metry element by 10° clockwise. With this feature is enabled, all geometry elements following the
modified line will also be rotated by 10° clockwise. With this feature is disabled, only the single line
element will be rotated by 10°.
- 129 -
Stonex FieldGenius
System Options
Show Tool Tips
When turned on, a "Tip of the Day" will be displayed when FieldGenius is started, and tooltips will be
displayed when you hover over any button.
Turning this off will hide the "Tip of the Day" dialog and will disable tooltips on buttons.
Communication Trace File
When turned on it will create a log file of the communication between FieldGenius and your instru-
ment, which can be used to diagnose communication problems and should only be used in this situ-
ation. The text file will be named TraceTS.txt or TraceGNSS.txt and will be created in the ...\Program
Files (x86)\Stonex\FieldGenius\9\ directory on your device.
Always Auto-Reconnect
When turned on it the program will always attempt to reconnect if communication drops between the
device and the collector.
Datum Warning Dialog
When turned on a warning will show up when the datum is changed so the user can move to use a
new datum.
Unit Settings
Main Menu | Settings | Units and Scale
The units and scale menu allows you to specify settings for your Project. Some of these settings are
recorded in the raw file and the Project's INI file, as well as recorded in the MSurvey.ini file.
Notes:
The Distance Unit (Meters or Feet) and Angle Unit (Degrees, Radians, or Gons) can
only be set when creating a new Project. After a Project has been created, these will
remain greyed-out and cannot be changed.
- 130 -
Main Menu
You can set these settings as defaults for new Projects by pressing the Save as Default Settings
button. The default settings can also be set in the Options screen.
Note: the actual precision on distances and angles returned from your instrument may be limited to
less than the precision you select here. Selecting a higher precision here will not increase the pre-
cision of values queried from your instrument.
Distance Unit
Choose the distance unit that you will be using: Meters, International Feet, or US Survey Feet. All dis-
tances will be displayed in the selected format. All distances will be recorded to the raw file in decimal
format. Database coordinates are always stored with 6 decimal places, and rounded to the desired
precision for display.
Meters
If you choose Meters as your distance unit, you can also specify the number of decimal places to dis-
play within FieldGenius, from 0 to 6.
International Feet / US Survey Feet
If you choose International Feet or US Survey Feet, then you can specify to use either a decimal
format with a precision from 0 to 6, or a Fractional format with feet and inches.
If you use the decimal format, distances will be displayed in decimal feet, such as 10.5' to indicate
10.5 feet or 10feet-6inches.
If you use the fractional format, distances will be displayed in feet and fractional inches, such as 10'6
1/2" to indicate 10feet-6.5inches or 10.54166667 feet.
- 131 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Angle Unit
Choose the angular unit that you will be using: Degrees, Gons/Gradients, or Radians. All angular val-
ues written into the raw file will be recorded in the selected format.
Degrees
If you select Degrees, then you can also select which format to use, either DDD°MM'SS.s" for
degrees-minutes-decimal seconds, DDD°MM.m' for degrees-decimal minutes, or DDD.d° for
decimal degrees. You can also specify the number of decimal places to use, from 0 to 8.
Gons (Gradients)
If you select Gons (Gradients) then you can also specify the number of decimal places to use, from 0
to 8.
Radians
If you select Radians then you can also specify the number of decimal places to use, from 0 to 8.
Direction Format
Choose the direction format that you will be using: North Azimuth, South Azimuth, or Bearings. When
entering a direction, you can always override this setting by entering the angle with the cardinal quad-
rant indicated before or after the angle. If there is no quadrant specified, then the input angle will be
interpreted as an Azimuth.
Scale Factor
You can use a scale factor to adjust ground distances to grid distances.
Distances measured with a total station will be recorded in the raw file with the unscaled, true meas-
ured slope distance. This scale factor is applied to the computation of coordinates only.
Distances entered using the Traverse/Intersect tool (COGO) will be scaled by the scale factor.
Distances calculated using the Inverse tool, or recalled using the pt..pt format will be scaled by the
inverse of this scale factor. The result will be the inversed grid distance times the inverse of the scale
factor, so that the ground distance is returned.
This Scale Factor does not affect any GNSS measurements. Please see the GNSS Local Trans-
formation topic for information on using a GNSS Scale Factor.
Curvature and Refraction Correction
When selected, the correction is applied to the computation of drawing coordinates only. Raw data
will not be altered in any way. When available from your instrument, we recommend the use of that
option and leave this setting toggled OFF in FieldGenius. Note: Be careful to not have this setting
toggled ON in both your instrument AND FieldGenius.
- 132 -
Main Menu
Save As Default
Use this to permanently write the current settings to the MSurvey.ini file. When you create a new Pro-
ject, it will use these settings. The default settings can also be set in the Options screen.
Coordinate Systems
Coordinate System Settings
Main Menu | Settings | Coordinate System
The coordinate system settings are used to transform GNSS derived curvilinear coordinates (latitude,
longitude and ellipsoidal height) into Cartesian coordinates (northing/y, easting/x, and ellipsoid or
orthometric height) for presentation on the drawing window and data storage.
Horizontal Group
Set the horizontal projected coordinate system for your Project.
The default coordinate system in FieldGenius is set to UTM83-11. Change this coordinate system as
appropriate for your region.
Edit List
The Edit List button opens the Coordinate System List dialog, which is used to add predefined or
user-defined coordinate systems to the list of selectable systems, create new coordinate systems,
copy predefined systems, and edit or delete existing systems.
- 133 -
Stonex FieldGenius
A predefined coordinate system is one that is included with FieldGenius by default, a user-defined
system is one that you have created.
More Info
Displays details about the selected coordinate system, including:
1. Ellipsoid parameters
2. The datum transformation method and parameters
3. The projection type and parameters
Vertical Group
Set the vertical system for your Project.
The default vertical datum is set to Ellipsoidal (WGS84), meaning that all GNSS derived heights will
be referenced to the WGS84 ellipsoid. The list of available systems includes all valid geoid model
files that are present within the Mapping directory of your FieldGenius installation. A geoid model is
required to reference GNSS derived heights to a geodetic datum. Please review the Geoid Model
topic for more details.
Save As Defaults
Saves the Horizontal and Vertical systems to the MSurvey.ini file as defaults to be used for all new
Projects.
Coordinate System List
The Coordinate System List dialog is where you can select an existing coordinate system or create a
new user-defined coordinate system and add them to a "favourites" list.
This list allows you to define the coordinate systems you uses most often for easy access from the
Coordinate System Settings screen.
- 134 -
Main Menu
Add
Add a new coordinate system to the list by one of three methods:
- 135 -
Stonex FieldGenius
1. Select Coordinate System From Database - Select one of the predefined coordinate sys-
tems. Coordinate systems are grouped into countries or mapping systems. Select the country
or system that you are surveying in and then choose the coordinate system in the System drop
down list. The section below the System field displays the projection, datum, and ellipsoid
information related to this coordinate system.
2. Create New User Coordinate System - Create a completely new coordinate system from
scratch with known parameters. Enter a name for your coordinate system and optionally enter
- 136 -
Main Menu
a description. NOTE: The system name must have colon in the name.
3. Create New User Coordinate System From Database Selection - Choose a predefined
coordinate system to populate parameters for a new coordinate system.
Edit
Edit a user-defined coordinate system. It is not possible to edit predefined coordinate systems.
Remove
Remove the selected coordinate system from the list. If the coordinate system is user-defined; you
will have the option to permanently delete the coordinate system. You may want to use the User
Coordinate System Export routine to save a backup copy of your user-defined coordinate system
before removing it permanently.
OK Button
This will save the coordinate system favourites list to the MSurvey.ini file.
Cancel Button
This will exit the dialog and will save nothing. You will be automatically returned to the Coordinate
System Settings dialog.
- 137 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Datum Parameters
There are 7 datum types to select from:
o Three Parameter
o Four Parameter
o Six Parameter
o Seven Parameter
o Bursa / Wolf
o DMA Molodensky
o None
If none is selected then no transformation parameters will be applied to the coordinate system trans-
formation.
If a datum other than none is selected then the user will be able to enter the following parameters:
o Delta X (m)
o Delta Y (m)
o Delta Z (m)
o X Rotation (“)
o Y Rotation (“)
o Z Rotation (“)
o Scale (PPM)
Projection Parameters
The user can select one of nineteen projections.
- 138 -
Main Menu
o Scale Factor
o Central Meridian
o Origin Latitude
o Origin Longitude
o False Northing
o False Easting
Automatic Backup
Whenever you add or edit a user-defined coordinate system, FieldGenius will automatically create
and save your parameters to a file named user-coordsys-backup.csmap to the mapping directory.
- 139 -
Stonex FieldGenius
This backup file stores your user-defined coordinate systems. If you accidentally remove or overwrite
your user-defined coordinate systems, you can re-import them from this backup file using the Import
user-defined Coordinate System command.
Localization (Site Calibration)
Further coordinate transformations can be accomplished with the use of the Local Transformation
function of FieldGenius. See the GNSS Local Transformation section for more information.
These settings are stored in your Project's INI file, allowing you to easily use different coordinate sys-
tems for different Projects.
Geoid Models
Geoid models are used by FieldGenius to convert ellipsoid heights to orthometric heights.
FieldGenius will by default use ellipsoid heights but you can define a geoid model to be used instead if
orthometric heights are desired.
Geoid models are not installed by default and must be downloaded from the MicroSurvey website.
Geoid models are available for most regions around the world.
Download Files and Instructions
Please review the following MicroSurvey Helpdesk article for instructions and country specific geoid
models: http://helpdesk.microsurvey.com/index.php?/Knowledgebase/Article/View/479
- 140 -
Main Menu
Keyboard Shortcuts
Main Menu | Settings | Keyboard Shortcuts
You can now assign command shortcuts to keys on your data collector. This has been added to sup-
port our new keyboard layout on the newer Trackers but it also works with any device that has a key-
board.
The defaults for the shortcut keys are based on the MicroSurvey Tracker custom keyboard layout, but
you can assign any key you want to the list of available commands. The shortcut definitions are
stored in the MSurvey.ini file so they're portable to your other data collectors if you've defined a cus-
tom layout.
Another great feature is that the EDM mode for the current instrument you have selected can have
shortcut keys assigned to them. For example if you refer to the list above, you would press the 1 key
to set your EDM mode on the instrument to IR Standard.
The shortcut keys will only function from the map screen.
Set Shortcut Key
Use this to assign a command to a key on your keyboard. Highlight the command you want to modify,
press the Set Shortcut Key button, then press the button on your keyboard to map the command to
it. Your new key map will automatically be saved to the MSurvey.ini file.
Disable Shortcut Key
Use this to disable individual shortcuts.
- 141 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Use this to set the currently selected command to the User Button found on the main interface. The
command currently set with the user button is indicated in the Function list with the same icon.
Reset All
This resets all the shortcuts to the factory defaults and all customized settings will be lost.
Disable All Shortcuts
This is a toggle that controls if the shortcut keys are disabled or enabled.
Default Shortcut Keys
Function Shortcut Key
Measure Point Enter
Sideshot (Auto Store) I
Sideshot J
Temporary Observation K
Distance offset E
Horizontal Angle Offset A
Multi-Set M
Resection R
Set Target Heights T
Occupy Point O
Check Backsight N
Check Point Q
Stake Points S
Staking List Z
Inverse B
Traverse / Intersect C
Station / Offset Y
Calculator F
AutoMap Library D
Figure List L
- 142 -
Main Menu
Language Selection
Main Menu | Settings | Language Selection
This screen will allow the user to specify what language is to be used at first launching of the pro-
gram. After the first run and selection, it will default to that language automatically. Note: The Lan-
guage Selection screen appears after installation is completed when the program is first launched or
the user can go into the Settings menu and choose Language Selection to switch to a different one is
desired.
- 143 -
Stonex FieldGenius
FieldGenius also allows the user to import in a Language Resource file (res*.dll) by scrolling down to
the bottom of the list and selecting the button "Select a Language Resource File"
AutoMap Library
Please see the AutoMap Library topic for details.
GroupCode Editor
Pre-defined groups are included with the default installation consisting of codes from the default
AutoMap library. Default Groups are stored in the Settings.xml file, and those default groups will auto-
matically be included when a new Project is created. There are two ways to create and edit Groups.
Main Menu | Settings | GroupCode Editor
- 144 -
Main Menu
The editor shows the active group and the codes defined within the group. Toggles and options are
also set from within the editor:
- 145 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Optionally copy the group items from another group in the current Project, or from the defaults stored
in the Settings.xml file.
- 146 -
Main Menu
Deleting a Group
Pick “Delete” to delete the active group. A confirmation dialog is displayed.
- 147 -
Stonex FieldGenius
l Zig-Zag pattern will cycle through the group, then reverse back through, and repeat
l Left to Right pattern will cycle through the group in a forward direction
l Right to Left pattern will cycle through the group in a reversed direction
l None pattern does not auto-select the next code, it is up to the user to pick the code
- 148 -
Main Menu
- 149 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Toggle Linework
Use the Line Toggle to switch the current linework toggle for the code. The options of “straight line”,
“second point on 3-point arc”, “spline”, and “none” are cycled.
Toggle Display
The “Show Button Panel” option can set the display mode to a grid of 12 buttons with the codes of the
group. The default display mode is the code carousel with the Map Screen visible.
- 150 -
Main Menu
Project Information
Main Menu | Settings | Project Information
- 151 -
Stonex FieldGenius
About FieldGenius
Main Menu | Settings | About
Use this to display information about the FieldGenius version you have installed or view what mod-
ules you have registered.
- 152 -
Main Menu
You will also see your Device ID and a series of fields where you can input the Key Code you
received from Stonex.
You will see an area that will show you the status of your license, including any modules that you cur-
rently have licensed. If you want to use FieldGenius in demo mode, press the Run Demo Mode but-
ton.
Please refer to the Registration & Demo Mode topic for further information.
- 153 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Use the vertical scroll bar along the side to access additional Measure Modes if they cannot all fit on
screen at the same time.
Note: Several of these Measure Modes will not be available until you have completed a setup.
Setup and Check
Backsight by 1 Point or Direction
Use this to define an instrument setup. Please see the Backsight Method topic for more information.
- 154 -
Main Menu
- 155 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Multi-Set
This will start the multi-set routine that will help you collect repeat observations to your backsight and
a new foresight point. Please see the Multi-Set topic for more information.
Staking
Please see the Staking Menu topic for more information.
Offsets
Distance Offset
This will start the distance offset routine. Please see the Distance Offset topic for more information.
Horizontal Angle Offset
This will start the angle offset routine. Please see the Horizontal Angle Offset topic for more inform-
ation.
Vertical Angle Offset
This will allow you to compute the height of an object. Please see the Vertical Angle Offset topic for
more information.
Line - Distance Offset
This allows you to measure two points to define a baseline, then manually enter measured distances.
These distances will be used to compute a new point based on the baseline. Please see the Line -
Distance Offset topic for more information.
Add Invert
Use this to open the invert toolbar. You will then be able to record invert measurements. Please see
the Add Invert topic for more information.
Intersections
Two Line Intersection
This allows you to measure two baselines and FieldGenius will compute the intersection point.
Please see the Two Line Intersection topic for more information.
Line - Angle Intersection
This allows you to measure two points to define a baseline, measure an angle, and FieldGenius will
compute the intersection point. Please see the Line - Angle Intersection topic for more information.
- 156 -
Main Menu
- 157 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Occupy Point
Type in an existing point number, or double tap in this field to open the keypad or to select a point from
the map. You will be able to create a new point, pick one from a list, or pick one from your drawing.
Instrument Height
Use this to enter your current instrument height.
Backsight Direction
Use this to specify the direction that will be used by FieldGenius. You can enter an azimuth or a quad-
rant bearing.
Target Height
Use this to enter your current target height.
- 158 -
Main Menu
Occupy Point
Type in an existing point number, or double tap in this field to open the keypad or to select a point from
the map. You will be able to create a new point, pick one from a list, or pick one from your drawing.
Instrument Height
Use this to enter your current instrument height.
Backsight Point
Type in an existing point number, or double tap in this field to open the keypad or to select a point from
the map. You will be able to create a new point, pick one from a list, or pick one from your drawing.
Backsight Direction & Distance
When you enter in your points FieldGenius will display the inversed horizontal distance and direction
between the points you entered.
Target Height
Use this to enter your current target height.
- 159 -
Stonex FieldGenius
1. You can always tell what mode you're in by the "mode" text that appears near the top of your
drawing. Since you're using the occupy point command you will see "Observe Backsight" near
the top of the map area.
2. You have two measure modes available to you on the instrument toolbar. You can measure an
angle and distance to the backsight, or measure only your current plate reading without meas-
uring a distance. The two options are described in more detail in the Backsight Measure Mode
topic.
3. You can cancel the setup by pressing the Measure Mode button and choosing "Cancel Back-
sight"
4. While in the backsight mode, you can use any of the controls from the information and display
toolbar.
5. You can set the height of target by using the HT button on the instrument toolbar.
6. When you're ready to measure to the backsight, press the Measure button on the instrument
toolbar.
Backsight Summary
After you have taken your measurement you will see a summary of your shot. From this screen you
can choose to accept the shot or re-shoot it. You can also specify if you want the plate reading set to
zero or a specific azimuth (if this is supported on your instrument). For more information see the Back-
sight Summary topic.
- 160 -
Main Menu
When shooting to your backsight you have two options available and they can be accessed from the
instrument toolbar using the Measure Mode button. The measure modes available are described as
follows:
Angle & Distance
Specifying this will require you to measure a distance to the backsight either to a prism or reflect-
orless. It will also record the current plate reading on the instrument. Both the measure distance and
plate reading will be used as the backsight reading in the raw file.
Angle Only
Specifying this will not require you to measure a distance to the backsight. All that will be recorded is
the current plate reading on the instrument and this reading will be used as the backsight reading in
the raw file.
Cancel Backsight
Use this to cancel your current backsight and occupy point command.
Backsight Summary
After you have taken your measurement you will see a summary of your shot. From this screen you
can choose to accept the shot or measure again. You can also specify if you want the plate reading
set to zero or a specific azimuth.
- 161 -
Stonex FieldGenius
1. The measured elevation of the occupy point, based on its previously recorded TR traverse
measurement.
2. The computed elevation of the occupy point, based on the backsight observation and the elev-
ation of the backsight point.
These two elevations for the occupy point are averaged together, and a new traverse observation is
computed for the occupy point, which will result in the occupy point having this new averaged elev-
ation. This computed observation is written to the raw file as a new TR record, overriding the previous
TR record to the occupy point.
- 162 -
Main Menu
Plate Setting
Finishing the Setup Routine
Accept
Once you've reviewed your backsight information you can complete it by pressing the Accept button.
This will write a record to the raw file and exit the setup routine.
If you specified the direction backsight method you will be prompted to "Store the point observed at
the backsight?" Press Yes to store a point for the backsight, or No to complete the setup without cre-
ating a new point at the backsight.
Observe Again
If you're not satisfied with the results or made a mistake you can re-shoot the backsight by using this
button. Doing so will take you back to the main display where you can take another shot on the back-
sight.
Occupy Point Raw Records
When you accept your occupy point, points will be stored in the database for the setup and backsight
if applicable. Also, the following records will be written to the raw file:
SP,PN2,N 918.0848,E 1057.3576,EL0.0000,--
--Orientation
LS,HI5.000,HR5.000
OC,OP1,N 1000.0000,E 1000.0000,EL0.0000,--
BK,OP1,BP2,BS145.00000,BC0.00000
BR,OP1,BP2,AR145.00000,ZE90.00000,SD100.00000
-- Orientation Notes (several comment lines)
If the "Reciprocate Traverse" option was used, then the following records will be written to the raw
file:
TR,OP1,FP3,AR45.00000,ZE90.00000,SD100.00000,-- (Note: this is the pre-
viously measured record, not part of the occupy routine)
--Reciprocate Traverse
LS,HI5.000,HR5.000
BK,OP1,BP2,BS0.00000,BC0.00000
TR,OP1,FP3,AR45.00000,ZE90.00150,SD100.0000,--
--Orientation
LS,HI5.000,HR5.000
OC,OP3,N 1070.7107,E 1070.7107,EL99.992,--
BK,OP3,BP1,BS225.00000,BC0.00000
BR,OP3,BP1,AR0.00000,ZE89.59300,SD100.01000
-- Orientation Notes (several comment lines)
- 163 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Multiple Backsight
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Setup & Check | Backsight by Multiple Points
or Directions
Multiple Backsight routine allows you to use multiple known control points to calculate a more accur-
ate backsight orientation.
Backsight by Multiple Points or Directions
Occupy Point
Your instrument location or Occupy Point can be entered here. Double click the empty will show a
drop-down list. You can then select the point from Map, List, or create a New point.
Instrument Height
Enter the height of your instrument set up, it will be used in the calculation.
Control Points Table
You can click the "Add" button to select backsight points, a minimum of 2 points are required for cal-
culation.
You can use the second column to select a desired backsight point, unchecked backsight points will
be used to improve the accuracy of the selected one.
- 164 -
Main Menu
After taking measurements for each control points entered, Multiple Backsight results screen will
show up to display calculated results and allow you to refine Azimuth Offset base on Offset Residual
values.
Control Points Table
l "Point" column - shows the Point ID for each control points measured
l "Use" column - allows you to toggle if the selected control point will be used in the calculation
or not.
l "Azimuth Offset" column - shows individual azimuth offset value for each control point.
l "Offset Residual" column - shows individual offset residual value, this value can be used to
access the accuracy of each control point.
l "HA Observed" column - shows the measured horizontal angle.
l "HD Observed" column - shows the measured horizontal distance.
l "HD Difference" column - shows the difference in horizontal distance.
Observe Again
This button allows you to re-measure the selected control point if the residual offset value is greater
than expected.
- 165 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Azimuth Offset
This is calculated Azimuth for your improved backsight direction. You can adjust this value by select-
ing desired control points from the above table. The Offset Residual column can be used to assess
the quality of each control point.
RMS
This is Root Mean Square (RMS) value for all selected Offset Residuals.
Once you are satisfied with the result, click 'OK' to "Backsight Summary" on page 161
Resection
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Setup & Check | Resection
FieldGenius has a multi-point resection routine that can be used to compute a point for a setup. It will
use a least squares solution to determine the coordinates from the measurements you make to your
points. The goal at the end of a resection is to compute the unknown coordinates of the instrument's
current location based on measurements made to other known points in the Project.
- 166 -
Main Menu
Second Shot
To record the second shot, simply select it from the map screen, then press the Measure button. A
minimum of two points are needed to compute a position for the instrument, but you can shoot more
points if needed to increase the accuracy of the instrument position. The estimated accuracy of the
instrument location will be displayed for you on the toolbar. If the estimated error is within your own tol-
erances, then you can go ahead and store the point by pressing the Store Point button. All suc-
cessful solutions will be displayed with green text starting with the characters StdDev:.
Press the Close button to cancel out of the routine. You may need to do this if the solution does not
converge, and you need to restart the routine.
- 167 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 168 -
Main Menu
You can determine how each shot to the reference points should be used to compute the resection
point. By default each observation you make will be used to compute both the horizontal and vertical
position of the resection solution, but you can override this by setting the Use H and Use V options
for each measurement.
Use H Use V Result
a a This shot will be used to compute both the horizontal and vertical position.
a r This shot will be used to compute only the horizontal position.
r a This shot will be used to compute only the vertical position.
r r The shot will be ignored in the computation.
You can also select which observation is to be your backsight point.
HA Error
The horizontal angle error is computed as follows. Using the computed resection point and the meas-
ured horizontal angle, a theoretical direction is computed to the reference point. This direction is then
compared to the direction measured (plate reading) and the difference is noted in the HA Err column.
HD Error
The horizontal distance error is computed as follows. An inverse is made between the resection point
and the reference point. This inversed distance is then compared to the measured distance and the dif-
ference is noted in the HD Err column.
- 169 -
Stonex FieldGenius
VD Error
The vertical distance error is computed as follows. Using the resection elevation, and the observation
to the reference point, a new elevation is computed for the reference point. This computed elevation is
then compared to the reference point's original elevation and the difference is noted in the VD column.
Resection Modes
At any time during the collection of your observations you can choose to shoot an Angle & Distance
or Angles Only measurement. You can control this by pressing the Measure Modes button on the
instrument toolbar after you have started your resection.
Store the Resection Point
When you're satisfied with the resection point you can store its new position by pressing the Store
Pnt button. This will then display the store / edit screen.
Finally you will see the backsight results screen.
The backsight point that will be stored will be based on which point you selected in the Information
screen shown above, which by default is the first reference point you observed. You do not need to
take another measurement to the backsight as it has the original measurement you made. At this
point you can do the following:
- 170 -
Main Menu
If you're satisfied with the backsight, you can store it by pressing the Accept button. If you're setting
a plate reading on the instrument, you need to make sure it is pointing at the backsight point prior to
pressing the Accept button. For example, if you want to set zero on the backsight point, you need to
make sure that the instrument is pointing at the backsight point.
Raw File Record
After you store the point, several records will be written to the raw file.
--Resection
SP,PN5000,N 1009.1534,E 1000.0000,EL100.3244,--
SP,PN6034,N 1006.1995,E 1002.8319,EL99.7321,--FS
SP,PN6035,N 1001.4706,E 1004.8775,EL99.7361,--FS
RS,PN5000,CR359.59590,ZE87.49010,SD9.1600
RS,PN6034,CR24.33000,ZE92.03450,SD6.8280
RS,PN6035,CR73.13080,ZE92.43050,SD5.1010
SP,PN6036,N 999.9998,E 999.9998,EL100.0011,--
OC,OP6036,N 999.9998,E 999.9998,EL100.0011,--
SP,PN5000,N 1009.1534,E 1000.0000,EL100.3244,--
BK,OP6036,BP5000,BS0.00039,BC0.00000
--Occupy Check
-- Observed Values: HA 0°00'00.0" VA 87°49'22.0" SD 9.160m HD 9.153m
-- Distance Calculated: 9.154m
-- Distance Error: -0.000m
-- BS Elevation: 100.324m
-- BS Elevation Error: 0.001m
Observe Benchmark
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Setup & Check | Observe Benchmark
Use this to check your current setup elevation or use it to establish an elevation for your setup. When
you start the command you will be taken to the main interface and you will note that the Measure
Mode will be set to Benchmark. If you need to cancel the operation you can do it by pressing the
Measure Mode button and choose the Cancel Benchmark button.
When you're ready to record the shot press the Measure button on the instrument toolbar. You will
then see the benchmark shot screen.
- 171 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Calculating an Elevation
Benchmark Method: Elevation
Use this option if you want to manually enter the know elevation for the point you're basing your shot
on. The elevation you enter will be used to calculate the elevation of the current setup. The difference
in the current and calculated elevations will be displayed towards the bottom of the screen. You can
enter in your know elevation in the BM Elevation field.
Benchmark Method: Point
Use this option if you want to base the calculated elevation on an existing point in your project. The
elevation of the point you choose will be used to calculate the elevation of the current setup. The dif-
ference in the current and calculated elevations will be displayed towards the bottom of the screen.
You can choose your point by using the point chooser button.
HI
This is where you would enter your height of instrument. Note this value will be used to compute the
new instrument elevation.
HT
This is where you would enter your height of target. Note this value will be used to compute the new
instrument elevation.
- 172 -
Main Menu
Set Elevation
Pressing this button will update your current setup elevation with the one calculated by the Bench-
mark Shot routine. You will be asked to confirm that you want to update the elevation. Two records
will be written to the raw file, a remote elevation (RE) and a store point (SP) record.
RE,OP1,FE0.000,ZE90.00000,SD10.0000,--Remote elev
SP,PN1,N 5001.0000,E 4978.0000,EL0.0240,--
Cancel
This will exit the routine and not save any changes.
Check Backsight
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Setup & Check | Check Backsight
Use this to check your backsight. FieldGenius will compare your newly measured value to the one
that was stored for your current setup. You will be able to review difference and optionally update your
current setup with the new shot to the backsight.
When you start the command you will be taken back to the map screen and the Measure Mode will be
set to Check BS. You have two measure modes available when taking a check shot to your back-
sight. Please see the Backsight Measure Mode topic for more information.
Check Backsight Summary
When you're ready to record the shot press the Measure button on the instrument toolbar. You will be
presented with a screen that compares your measured values to the ones that were stored for the cur-
rent backsight.
- 173 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Update Backsight
Pressing this will create a record in the raw file updating your setup and backsight record with the shot
information from your check shot. Several notes will also be written to the raw file summarizing your
shot. When you choose to update the backsight, a new OC and BK record is saved as well as the
shot information. You will also see the word (Updated) which indicates that the user selected the
Update button.
OC,OP5,N 763.8748,E 1000.0000,EL0.0000,--
SP,PN1,N 1000.0000,E 1000.0000,EL100.0000,--start
BK,OP5,BP1,BS0.00000,BC0.00000
LS,HI0.000,HR5.000
--Backsight Check (Updated)
-- Observed Values: HA 0°00'00.0" VA 90°00'00.0" SD 163.12'
-- Backsight Setup: 0°00'00"
-- Backsight Measured: 0°00'00"
-- Backsight Error: 0°00'00"
-- Distance Calculated: 236.13'
-- Distance Measured: 163.12'
-- Distance Error: 73.01'
OK
Pressing this will exit the function and write several notes to the raw file summarizing your check
shot.
--Backsight Check (Not Updated)
-- Observed Values: HA 0°00'00.0" VA 90°00'00.0" SD 236.10'
-- Backsight Setup: 0°00'00"
- 174 -
Main Menu
Check Point
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Setup & Check | Check Point
Use this to measure a check shot to an existing point. When you start the command you will see the
point chooser appear where you can create a new point or pick an existing one from a list or from the
screen. After you choose your point you will be ready to measure. You will note the Measure Mode
will be set to Check Pnt and if you need to cancel the operation you can do it by pressing the Meas-
ure Mode button and choose to cancel it.
Check Point Summary
When you're ready to record the shot press the Measure button on the instrument toolbar. You will be
presented with a screen that compares your measured values to the ones that were computed for the
check shot point.
The deltas that are displayed are computed by subtracting the shot coordinates from the known
coordinates. In other works if you add the deltas to the shot point coordinates you will end up at the
known point.
- 175 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Store Point
Pressing this will exit the function and write several notes to the raw file summarizing your check
shot, and allow you to store the shot using the Store/Edit Point screen.
--Check Point
-- Check Point ID: 110
-- Check Point dNorthing: -4.59'
-- Check Point dEasting: -1.82'
-- Check Point dElevation: -4.96'
-- Check Point dHorizontal: 4.94'
-- Observed Values: HA 45°00'00.0" VA 90°00'00.0" SD 23.00' HR 5.00'
-- Observed Point Northing: 5016.26'
-- Observed Point Easting: 5016.26'
-- Observed Point Elevation: 95.00'
Close
This will exit the check shot function and not write anything to the raw file or storing a new point.
Note:
When measuring in temp mode, nothing will be recorded in the RAW file.
- 176 -
Main Menu
Sideshot
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Sideshot
If you like reviewing your shots prior to being stored in the database and raw file, then this is the mode
you should use. When you press the measure button on the instrument toolbar, after the shot is meas-
ured you will see the store point screen prior to storing the point.
When you set this mode you will see the word Sideshot on the Measure Modes button.
When you complete the measurement using the measure button you will see the Store/Edit Point
screen.
You can also confirm or change the Target Height used for this shot.
After reviewing the information you have three options to choose from:
Store As Side Shot
The default selection, will store the coordinate in the database and create a sideshot record (SS) in
the raw file.
SS,OP350,FP3,AR0.00000,ZE94.50090,SD13.2700,--<No Desc>
- 177 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Traverse records are needed if you want to compute a traverse closure. If your last shot from a setup
is recorded as a traverse record, when you use the occupy point routine it will automatically advance
you. This is commonly referred to as "leap frogging" your traverse.
Store As Averaged Point
Select this option to use the observation for Point Averaging. If you set the Point ID to a value of an
existing point and store as Side Shot or Traverse Shot, the option to enter Point Averaging will be
presented.
Store Pnt
Press this to store the point in the coordinate database and update the raw file.
Cancel
Press this to cancel the shot and not store anything.
Note: For more information on the other buttons found on this screen please read the Store / Edit
Points topic.
- 178 -
Main Menu
Use this when you have production in mind and you don't need to review your shots before they're
recorded in the database and raw file. The Measure Mode allows you to press the measure button and
it will store the point in the database and plot it in the drawing without asking you for any further inform-
ation.
When in this mode you will see the words Sideshot (Auto) on the Measure Mode button.
It will use the following settings from the main interface when storing the point:
Next Point Number ID
The current point ID on the topo toolbar will be assigned to the point.
Description
The current description on the topo toolbar will be assigned to the point.
Height of Target
The current HT on the instrument toolbar will be used to compute the elevation of the point.
Note:
When measuring in the Auto Store mode, a SS record will be recorded in the raw file.
GroupCode
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | GroupCode
Overview
GroupCode is a Measure Mode that allows the user to set up a Group of Codes that have a common
theme or purpose, and is ideal to increase productivity for repetitive feature collection. GroupCode
allows:
- 179 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Operation Notes
For Total Station operation there are two Measure Modes:
l GroupCode – This mode displays the “Store Point” screen to allow editing of Advanced
Options or to confirm Code and Linework options
l GroupCode (Auto) – This mode is similar to “Sideshot (Auto Store)” where the observation is
automatically stored after the measurement is completed
See the GroupCode Editor topic for information about setting up a group and changing its behaviours.
- 180 -
Main Menu
Workflow
The GroupCode feature is designed to allow fast measuring, and as such the automation of the code
selection and multiple linework figures can reduce the task to a simple measurement button press.
When no pattern is set, the user will manually need to select the next code to use, and line toggles
will be necessary for drawing arcs.
Entering Offsets
It is possible to pre-enter distance offsets that will be applied to the next measurement. The Offset
button will display the offset directions that will be applied if the offsets are set. Forward/Back,
Left/Right, and Up/Down.
- 181 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The offset entry screen has numerous toggles that can be used to set the values:
GroupCode (Auto)
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | GroupCode (Auto)
This Measure Mode automatically stores the observation with the selected code and the Next Point
ID, otherwise identical to the main GroupCode feature.
Multi-Set
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Multi-Set
The Multiset routine in FieldGenius allows you to record angular sets in any order you want. You can
also review your measurement's computed average and standard deviation.
- 182 -
Main Menu
You will then see the Setup Occupy Point screen. If you've already established a setup, it will display
the same information that you previously entered.
Press the Continue Multi-Set button to proceed to the Multi-Set Point List screen
Note:
Unlike the regular setup routine, you will not be required to immediately shoot your
backsight.
- 183 -
Stonex FieldGenius
This is the control center for recording your sets. It will begin with a record for your backsight and your
foresight measurements will be listed after it, in order that they are measured.
Pnt: This is the point number of the point you've measured for your backsight and foresight points. If
you see the word "Bearing" this indicates that you assumed a backsight direction.
Type: This is the type of measurement that was measured. It will be either a BS (backsight) or FS
(foresight) measurement.
Obs F1:This will list the total Face 1 (Direct) observations that were recorded for the point.
Obs F2: This will list the total Face 2 (Reverse) observations that were recorded for the point.
Saved: If the foresight measurement hasn't been saved you will see a red "X". measurements that
have been saved will have a green "checkmark". Since your backsight readings are always to a
known point or an assumed direction you will see N/A as there is nothing to save.
Measuring the Backsight
If you want to shoot your backsight, then do the following.
- 184 -
Main Menu
1. Select the first row which is the backsight record by tapping on it.
2. Press the Measure button to start the measurement process.
3. On the map screen confirm that you have selected the correct target height.
4. When you're ready to record the measurement press the Measure button on the instrument
toolbar.
5. You will automatically see the multiset point list where you will see your measurement which
will be indicated in the F1 or F2 field.
The summary will display the standard deviations for the averaged measurements as well as the com-
puted average measurement. In the list you will see the delta difference between the measured meas-
urement and the average. In our example the HA and VA on the face 1 measurement was larger than
the average direction by 11 seconds.
By default all measurements will be used to compute the averaged position. However, you can
decide what measurements you want to use to compute the averaged position by pressing the green
checkmark icon. Doing so will switch it to a red "X" which will remove it from the computation.
Notes about measuring the Backsight:
When you first begin the multi-set routine, you are not required to shoot the backsight prior to meas-
uring a foresight.
- 185 -
Stonex FieldGenius
You are not required to have both a Face 1 and Face 2 reading recorded for the backsight. A meas-
urement on either face will work, but it is common practice to record both.
Measuring a Foresight
To record a foresight measurement you first have to define a point number in the Point ID field
towards the top of the multi-set point list. Press the Next button to display the next available point ID,
or type in the Point ID you want to use. Then press the Add button to add the new Point ID into the
Multi-Set Point List. After you add the new point number follow these steps to record the meas-
urement.
Towards the top you will see the foresight point you measurement to and a summary of the total face
1 and face 2 measurements recorded.
- 186 -
Main Menu
Next you will see the standard deviation that is computed using all the directions that have a green
check mark.
Next is the averaged direction (plate reading) to the foresight point.
Finally, you will see the computed clockwise angle between the average backsight and foresight dir-
ection.
By default all measurements will be used to compute the averaged position. However, you can
decide what measurements you want to use to compute the averaged position by pressing the green
checkmark icon. Doing so will switch it to a red "X" which will remove it from the computation.
Once you're satisfied with your observations you can press the Store Pnt button which will take you
to the Store and Edit screen. From here you can review the description and store it as either a SS or
TR measurement.
Note: After you store your point, you will not be able to add anymore observations.
Auto Turn Sets
If you have a motorized instrument you will be able to have FieldGenius plunge your scope and turn
back to the foresight or backsight for you.
Simply highlight the measurement you want to record an observation for, and select the Auto Turn
option so the checkbox is checked.
Now when you press the Measure button the instrument will automatically plunge and turn back to
your foresight point for you. You can then press the measure button on the instrument toolbar to
record the measurement.
When you're using the Auto Turn option FieldGenius will first check to see how many Face 1 and
Face 2 observations you have. It will automatically keep these numbers equal to one another. For
example if you have 1 Face1 measurement, and 2 Face2 measurements, FieldGenius will auto-
matically sight the foresight using Face 1.
Furthermore, if you're instrument is equipped with auto target recognition, you can use this feature in
combination with the auto turn for greater productivity.
Multiset Measure Modes
At any time during the collection of your observations you can choose to shoot an angle & distance or
angles only measurement. You can control this by pressing the Measure Modes button on the instru-
ment toolbar.
If you're measuring to a foresight you need a minimum of 1 distance before you will be allowed to
store it.
- 187 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Staking
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Staking
See the Staking topic for more information.
Offsets
Distance Offset
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Offsets | Distance Offset
FieldGenius allows you to do a distance offset to specify an offset forward or backward along the line
of sight, left or right, and vertically up or down.
- 188 -
Main Menu
When you choose distance offset command and take a measurement, you will see the following
screen:
From this screen you can specify if the offsets are with respect to the instrument or prism.
l Offset buttons act as toggles, which allow you to easily define the direction the offset should
be applied.
l A negative offset will automatically be converted to a positive value.
l The elevation of the point will be computed from your shot. This elevation will remain
unchanged unless you specify a vertical offset.
l The distance is assumed to be horizontal.
- 189 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 190 -
Main Menu
Two observations are required: one to record the angle to the point of interest, and a second to meas-
ure a distance perpendicular to the point.
On this screen you determine what order you will make these two measurements. All you need to do
is press either the Observe Angle or Observe Distance button.
Note: You can increase the size of the text shown in the grid by setting the Text Size option in the
Options screen.
Note: The Quick Measure Modes option in the Options screen will affect what happens when you
press the Observe buttons when you are using the offset routines. If Quick Measure Modes is on, a
measurement will automatically be taken. If it is off, the Observe button doesn't actually trigger your
total station to take a measurement; it simply takes you to the map screen where you can press the
measure button once you are ready to take the measurement.
- 191 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Angle (Center)
This will record the total station's horizontal angle. When measuring the angle, you should point the
total station towards the center of the new point that will be created. This would be measurement "A"
in the diagram shown above.
Note: You do not need to sight a prism to record the angle, simply sight the new point and press the
Observe Angle button.
Distance
This will record a distance, measured to a prism which is located at the side of the object. You should
try to locate the prism so that it is perpendicular to the center of the object and the line-of-sight from
the total station. This is measurement "B" in the diagram shown above.
Note: The target height is important on this shot, because the new point will have the same elevation.
Storing the Shot
After you record your measurements you can store the new point by pressing the Store Point button.
After you store the point, you can continue using the offset command to record additional points, or
exit it by pressing the Cancel button.
Raw File Record
In the raw file the OF records represent the measurements that were made and the SS record is
derived using the two OF records
OF,AR94.49380,ZE88.41340,SD27.3163
OF,OL93.25450,--Right Angle Offset
- 192 -
Main Menu
SS,OP1,FP23,AR93.25450,ZE88.41340,SD27.3081,--ROAD
On this screen you determine what order you will make these two measurements. All you need to do
is press either the Observe Angle or Observe Distance button.
Note: You can increase the size of the text shown in the grid by setting the Text Size option in the
Options screen.
Note: The Quick Measure Modes option in the Options screen will affect what happens when you
press the Measure button when you are using the offset routines. If Quick Measure Modes is on, a
measurement will automatically be taken. If it is off, the measure button doesn't actually trigger your
total station to take a measurement; it simply takes you to the map screen where you can press the
measure button once you are ready to take the measurement.
- 193 -
Stonex FieldGenius
For example if point "B" was the bottom of an underpass, you could measure its height. Usually it is
easier if you position the prism so it is directly beneath the point you want to shoot. You would then
record a distance observation to this location which will also be the horizontal position for the new
point. Then without turning your instrument, you could rotate the scope vertically so it is sighted on
the bottom of the overpass. You could then record this observation which will be used to compute the
elevation for the new point.
Once you've recorded these two measurements, you will be able to store the new position.
Storing the Shot
After you make your measurements, you will be able to store the new point. Press the Store Point
button to store the point.
Raw File Record
In the raw file the OF records represent the measurements that were made. The SS record is the
record that was used to compute the coordinate point for the angle offset and will be a compilation of
your two shots.
OF,AR52.53170,ZE91.12240,SD9.5616
OF,ZE91.12240,--Vert Angle Offset
SS,OP1,FP2,AR52.53170,ZE91.12240,SD9.5616,--<No Desc>
- 194 -
Main Menu
When you define your reference line, there are three types of offset that can be applied.
You can define a horizontal offset, a perpendicular offset and a vertical (elevation) offset. Each offset
button is a toggle that allows you to toggle how the offset is to be applied in relation to the reference
line.
When you define the offset direction, you can then enter in the value that you want to offset by.
If the horizontal offset remains set to zero, perpendicular or elevation offset will be applied in relation
to point one on the reference line.
Offsets
Horizontal Offset
The horizontal offset can either be left or right of the first point on the reference line. From the total sta-
tion's perspective, if the new point is to the right of point 1, then you would use the Horz Offset Right
of Pnt 1. If it is to the left, then logically, it would be a left offset so you would use the Horz Offset Left
of Pnt 1 setting.
Perpendicular Offset
The perpendicular offset is a horizontal distance applied perpendicular to the reference line. From the
total station's perspective, when moving perpendicular from the reference line, if the new point ends
up being closer to the total station, then you would set the perpendicular offset to Perp Offset
Towards Inst. Alternatively, if the new point ends up being farther from the total station, then you
would use the Perp Offset Away From Inst.
- 195 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Elevation Offset
This is the vertical offset from the reference line to the new point. If the new point is above the ref-
erence line, then you would set this to Elev Offset Up. If the new point is below the reference line you
would set it to Elev Offset Down.
Measure Points
When you start line angle offset command, you will see an empty list.
Highlight the row that you would like to make a measurement for and simply press the Measure but-
ton to begin the measuring process.
If you need to redo a measurement, simply highlight it in the list and press the measure button.
Notes:
1. The northing and easting values for the new point will be computed using the horizontal and per-
pendicular offsets defined by the user. These horizontal offset is referenced to point 1 on the ref-
erence line. The perpendicular offset is a perpendicular offset from the reference line.
2. The z value for the new point will be computed using the projected elevation along the reference
line, plus or minus any elevation offsets defined by the user.
Note: You can increase the size of the text shown in the grid by setting the Text Size option in the
Options screen.
- 196 -
Main Menu
Example
The top corner in a closet needs to be located, but it isn't visible from the total station.
So the user lays a hand tape on the floor, with the start of the tape located at the bottom corner of the
closet, directly below the point that needs to be recorded. The direction of the tape is then laid out
such that two measurements can be made on the tape.
Essentially, the tape now becomes the reference line. Two shots are taken, one at the 2 foot mark,
and the other at the 5 foot mark.
- 197 -
Stonex FieldGenius
After you take your two measurements, all you need to define is the offset distances. In this example,
the corner is two feet to the right of the first measurement (point 1), and 8' up from the floor. After you
define the offset directions and offset amounts, you can press the Store Pnt button to store the new
point.
Add Invert
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Offsets | Add Invert
If you've manually measured a distance to an invert, you can have FieldGenius compute a point with
a computed invert elevation.
When you start the command you will see the Invert Toolbar appear towards the bottom of your main
screen.
First you need to specify the point that will be referenced to compute the invert elevation. You can do
this by using the point chooser button.
Now enter the measured distance to the inverse. For example if your measurement was 5.5',
FieldGenius will subtract this from the reference point's elevation. Entering a negative value will
cause it to be added.
- 198 -
Main Menu
Press Store Point to create and save a point with the calculated invert distance. This point will have
the same northing and easting value as the reference point.
Note:
While the invert toolbar is open, you can continue entering invert measurements or
choose different reference points.
Raw File
When you save the point, an offset and store point record will be created.
--OS,OP7,FP8,ND0.000,ED0.000,LD5.000
SP,PN8,N 935.976,E 1232.356,EL5.000,--<No Desc>
Intersections
Two Line Intersection
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Intersections | Two Line Intersection
The two line intersection command is used to locate the corner of an object, whose corner cannot be
directly measured. Two intersecting lines will be defined by four measurements, two shots on each
line. The intersection of these two lines will define the corner of the object. This routine is intended to
be used with a reflectorless total station.
Measure Points
When you start the two line intersection command, you will see an empty list. Each row represents a
measurement to a point on one of the two lines needed to compute the intersection.
Highlight the row that you would like to make a measurement for and simply press the Measure but-
ton to begin the measuring process.
If you need to redo a measurement, simply highlight it in the list and press the measure button.
- 199 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Notes:
1. You can shoot the points in any order you like, FieldGenius will determine what direction to go in to
compute an intersection
2. The northing and easting values for the new point will be computed using the intersection of the two
lines.
3. The two lines you define will rarely intersect at exactly the same point. The elevation of where the
lines intersect will be averaged, and used as the z value for the new point.
Note: You can increase the size of the text shown in the grid by setting the Text Size option in the
Options screen.
Store the Point
Once you've made measurements to the four points that will define the two intersection lines, you can
press the Store Point button. This will store a point in the map screen, store a point in the database as
well as record information to the raw file.
Raw File
Everything about the intersection is stored in the raw file.
--Two Line Intersection
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR280.55220,ZE81.15170,SD6.8350,--Pnt 1 of Line 1
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR276.59380,ZE81.05590,SD6.4400,--Pnt 2 of Line 1
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR287.18580,ZE81.13350,SD6.7960,--Pnt 1 of Line 2
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR296.06280,ZE80.14520,SD6.0940,--Pnt 2 of Line 2
SP,PN3,N -0.0039,E -0.0060,EL0.5325,--
- 200 -
Main Menu
An example of where you might use this is to locate the corner wall of a building. Simply shoot two
points on one of the walls, then turn the instrument so it is pointing anywhere along the corner of the
building. This command is intended to be used with reflectorless total stations.
Measure Points
When you start the Line-Angle Intersection command, you will see an empty list.
Highlight the row that you would like to make a measurement for and simply press the Measure but-
ton to begin the measuring process.
If you need to redo a measurement, simply highlight it in the list and press the measure button.
Notes:
1. You can shoot the points in any order you like, FieldGenius will determine what direction to go in to
compute an intersection
2. The northing and easting values for the new point will be computed using the intersection of the line
and the angle that was read.
3. The z value for the new point will be computed using the projected elevation along the reference
line to the point where an intersection is computed.
- 201 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Note: You can increase the size of the text shown in the grid by setting the Text Size option in the
Options screen.
Store the Point
Once you've made your measurements that will be used to compute the intersection, you can press
the Store Point button. This will store a point in the map screen, store a point in the database as well
as record information to the raw file.
Raw File
Everything about the intersection is stored in the raw file.
--Line - Angle Offset
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR280.55530,ZE81.12550,SD6.8330,--Pnt 1 of Line
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR277.37420,ZE80.47010,SD6.5020,--Pnt 2 of Line
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR283.46460,ZE86.15500,--Angle Offset
SP,PN4,N -0.0050,E 0.0051,EL0.5761,--
- 202 -
Main Menu
An example of where you could use this is to pick up the corner of a building, whose corner cannot be
scene from the total station. You could take two shots on one wall to define the reference line, and
then take another shot on the intersecting wall. A perpendicular intersection will be computed, which
in this case would be the corner of the building.
Measure Points
When you start the command, you will see an empty list.
Highlight the row that you would like to make a measurement for and simply press the Measure but-
ton to begin the measuring process.
If you need to redo a measurement, simply highlight it in the list and press the measure button.
Notes:
1. The northing and easting values for the new point will be computed by computing a perpendicular
intersection between the reference line and a point defined by the user.
2. The z value for the new point will be computed using the projected elevation along the reference
line to the point where a perpendicular intersection occurs.
- 203 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Note: You can increase the size of the text shown in the grid by setting the Text Size option in the
Options screen.
Select Perpendicular Point
You can define the perpendicular point one of two ways. The first is to simply take a measurement
that will define the perpendicular point. The shot is only used to make an intersection, a point isn't
stored at the measurement location.
The other method is to choose an existing point that exists in your scene. Press the Select Per-
pendicular Pnt button to select a point.
Store the Point
Once you’ve made your measurements and defined a perpendicular point that will be used to compute
the intersection, you can press the Store Point button. This will store a point in the map screen, store
a point in the database as well as record information to the raw file.
Raw File
Everything about the intersection is stored in the raw file. In the following example, if you shot the per-
pendicular point you will see a third shot that records the measurement.
--Line - Perpendicular Point
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR353.49130,ZE80.47360,SD21.3386,--Pnt 1 of Line
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR357.07260,ZE81.13020,SD22.4245,--Pnt 2 of Line
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR12.10230,ZE83.00580,SD19.8819,--Perpendicular Pnt
SP,PN6,N 123.3028,E 100.0209,EL104.7737,--RM
- 204 -
Main Menu
If the perpendicular point exists in your scene and you selected it using the point chooser, then you
will see a store point recorded as a note. The last store point is the new point that was computed.
--Line - Perpendicular Point
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR353.49520,ZE80.46560,SD21.3419,--Pnt 1 of Line
--HI1.340,HR0.000,AR357.07330,ZE81.12210,SD22.4147,--Pnt 2 of Line
--SP,PN7,N 119.2906,E 104.1611,EL103.7580,--Perpendicular Pnt
SP,PN8,N 123.3107,E 100.0504,EL104.7751,--SCR
Trilateration
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Intersections | Trilateration
This routine allows you to trilaterate the position of new points by observing their distances from two
known positions. The two known points will make up a baseline, from which a distance-distance inter-
section will be calculated to determine the position of each new point.
The primary use of this routine is for GNSS users so they can locate inaccessible points. They can
locate two points with GNSS, and then use the Trilateration routine to locate the inaccessible points.
This routine can accept distances measured with the Leica Disto.
- 205 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Add Point
Use this to add a new unknown point to solve for. When you press this, you will be prompted for the
new point number and description, and whether it is on the left or right side of the baseline.
Save Point
This saves the selected New Point into your Project database.
Switch Side
This toggles the selected New Point to the Left or Right side of the baseline.
Map View
This takes you to a map view showing your baseline, the distance measured from each point, and the
calculated position of the new point.
- 206 -
Main Menu
If desired, you can press the World View button on the Display toolbar to hide unnecessary data.
Measure from Point 1
Press this to record the distance from Point 1 of your baseline to the selected New Point.
Measure from Point 2
Press this to record the distance from Point 2 of your baseline to the selected New Point.
- 207 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Note: You need to measure and store the points that will be used to define the vertical mapping plane,
prior to starting the Vertical Projection command.
When ready to continue, press the OK button.
You will now be in the Vertical projection mode which will be indicated by the Measure Mode button
on the instrument toolbar. To begin calculating points on the vertical plane, you need to point the total
station at the new point you want to create. To complete the shot, press the measure button, and then
store the point.
Note: You do not need to use a prism when measuring points on the vertical plane. Simply point the
instrument at the point you want to create.
Since vertical planes represent 3D data, it is sometimes necessary to rotate your perspective of the
Project to help you see the point you're computing on the vertical plane.
Press the 3D View button on the display toolbar which will open the 3D toolbar. If you press the
Planar View button, your scene will be rotated so it matches your perspective. For example, a vertical
plane was defined by points 27 and 28. When the planar view option is used, you can see your work in
a 3D perspective. You can now see the 4 measurements (points 500 – 503) that were made to record
the position of a window on the vertical plane.
- 208 -
Main Menu
- 209 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Point Scanning
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Point Scanning
FieldGenius supports point scanning which allows you to create a point cloud of data. To use this
routine you need a reflectorless instrument that has servo motors.
To start, you will be asked to define a scan area by pressing the Measure Range button and pointing
the instrument at the Bottom-Left and Top-Right corners of the area you want to confine the scanning
to.
Once the scan area is defined, you can define the scan resolution by using an angular value. For
example if you set it to 0°30'00", FieldGenius will create a pattern confined to the limits you defined,
and scan at 30 minute intervals both horizontally and vertically. Once you've defined the scan area
and resolution, FieldGenius will display an estimate of how many points will be stored.
You also can control how FieldGenius deals with measurement errors while scanning. If you turn on
"Ignore all scanning errors", FieldGenius will ignore measurement errors and continue without inter-
ruption. If you don't turn this on, FieldGenius will stop and display a message allowing you to stop the
scanning process, or continue on with the next measurement.
Press the Start Scan button to select the desired reflectorless EDM Mode and initiate scanning.
FieldGenius will display an estimate of the time remaining for the scan to complete.
Points will be stored using the description defined in the map screen. The point number of the first
point will be set to the "next available" id and will increment sequentially. The shots are stored in the
raw file as sideshots so you have a record of the observations.
- 210 -
Main Menu
Upon completion, you will receive a summary showing the total number of successful measurements
and errors received.
Scan Settings
When connected to the Leica MS50/MS60 and you select the Point Scanning command you will see
the Scan Settings dialog.
Scan Settings - Type
Scan Method
You have 4 options
l Polygon area - Scan area confined by polygon vertices (video scanning supported)
l Rectangular area - Scan a rectangular area defined by 2 opposite corners (video scanning sup-
ported)
l Full Dome - Scan the entire field of view of the total station
l Partial Dome - Scan area confined by angler constraints. Can also be used to scan Ceilings or
Floors
Scan Rate
Define the scan rate you want to use. High density scans require more time to complete, while lower
density scans require less time.
Store SNR
Use this to control the recording of SNR data on each point captured with the MS50/MS60.
Artifact Filter
Use this to help eliminate ghost points and enhances the point cloud quality.
- 211 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 212 -
Main Menu
- 213 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Maximum BitRate
This setting controls the maximum video data transfer rate between total station and your data col-
lector.
Lower this setting if you are experiencing high latency, slow response time, or video flickering in video
extents view when using Bluetooth PAN connection.
We recommend lowest setting for Bluetooth PAN connection due to limited wireless bandwidth, and
highest setting for USB Cable connection. (These are default settings)
l Install Leica MS50/MS60 driver or Leica Viva/Captivate software that contains the driver on
the PC/Tablet you wish to run FieldGenius
l Connect Leica Lemo 8-pin to USB cable to the PC/Tablet
- 214 -
Main Menu
l On a Bluetooth capable Windows PC or tablet, go to Control Panel -> Network and Sharing
Center -> Change Adapter Settings
l Locate Bluetooth Network Connection, right click on the icon and select Properties.
l Under Networking tab, click on Internet Protocol Version 4 (TCP/IPv4), then click on Prop-
erties again
l Select Use the following IP address:, and enter 192.168.253.100 as IP address, and
255.255.255.0 as Subnet mask
l Click OK twice to save the settings
- 215 -
Stonex FieldGenius
l Now go to Control Panel -> View Devices and Printers or alternatively right click
Bluetooth task bar status icon, and select Show Bluetooth Devices
l From either places, click Add a device button to add MS50/MS60 (names as TS or
TSxxxxxx) as a device. Make sure the instrument is turned on and within range.
l When asked for pairing code or PIN, make sure to enter 0000 as code on both Windows and
MS50/MS60 instrument.
l The MS50/MS60 instrument is now successfully paired with your PC/Tablet. All steps above
are one time only
l Once the initial setup is completed, you should be able to see your instrument under
Bluetooth devices or Devices and Printers screen
l Right click the MS50/MS60 instrument, select Connect using, then click Ad hoc network
l Windows may take a few seconds to finish the connection. You are now good to go!
- 216 -
Main Menu
l If your Bluetooth PAN connection is unstable or video camera cannot be started, you can fol-
low the steps below to reset the connection
l Remove MS50/MS60 instrument from Bluetooth device list on your PC/Tablet
l On MS50/MS60, hold the Power button, and choose Reset, and select Reset Windows CE.
This will clear WinCE system settings.
l Follow the steps above to re-add MS50/MS60 instrument in the Bluetooth device using
PIN code 0000
A practical application of the donut mode would be to either scan Ceilings or Floors by limiting the 2
vertical angles.
- 217 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 218 -
Main Menu
- 219 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 220 -
Main Menu
On-Axis Camera
l Move the crosshair to the edge of the scanning area by directly clicking the video itself.
l Zoom to the appropriate level
l Click "Add Vertex" button to add the first polygon vertex.
l Repeat previous steps until the scan area is defined.
Scan Complete
When Point Scanning is completed, a few options will be available to you.
- 221 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Manual
Manual Entry
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Manual | Manual Entry
When you set the Measure Mode to manual entry on the instrument toolbar you will be required to
manually input your measurements. When you press the measure button you will see the following
screen:
Tip:
- 222 -
Main Menu
You can also use the Manual Entry mode for repeating your last shot. If you have pre-
viously taken a measurement, then the angle and distance values on this screen will
default to those of your previous shot.
Manual Distance
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Manual | Manual Distance
Use this mode to shoot an observation where only the horizontal and zenith angles will be measured
with the instrument. You will be then prompted to enter the distance.
When you set the Measure Mode to manual distance and press the measure button the horizontal and
vertical angles will be read from your total station. Since this is only measuring angles, you do not
need to have a prism to shoot to.
Following this you will see a screen allowing you to enter a horizontal distance.
Press OK to save the point. You will now see the measurement info screen.
A regular sideshot or traverse record will be created in the raw file.
- 223 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 224 -
Main Menu
Overview
There are three different modes available for programming a position into your reference receiver.
When you're ready to program your base receiver with a position you need to select the reference pos-
ition mode then to start the process press the Measure button on the GNSS toolbar. Please review
the following sections for a detailed explanation of how each mode is used.
- 225 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Geodetic Coordinates
Enter the know Latitude, Longitude and Ellipsoidal Height for your base setup. The coordinates you
enter here will be programmed into the receiver.
Cartesian Coordinates
Cartesian coordinates can be SPCS, UTM coordinates or any other grid system as long as it
matches the horizontal and vertical system you've defined in your GNSS profile. You cannot enter
local coordinates as Cartesian coordinates! Doing so will cause a warning message to be displayed
indicating that the coordinates you entered do not fall inside the GNSS grid files you have loaded on
your data collector.
Select Position from Database
This allows you to choose a point a number of different ways. The point you select must be a grid
coordinate such as a SPCS or UTM coordinate.
- 226 -
Main Menu
It is up to you to determine how many observations or the duration of time you want to wait before
accepting the averaged position. At any time you can restart the process by pressing the Reset Aver-
age button.
If you press Set Position, your receiver will be programmed with the new position and you will have
the option of storing a point's position in the database.
- 227 -
Stonex FieldGenius
When this option is used, FieldGenius starts receiving data and computes an averaged Autonomous
position for the base receiver. The current position, how many epochs it has received and the total
elapsed time is displayed on the screen.
It is up to you to determine how many observations or the duration of time you want to wait before
accepting the averaged position. At any time you can restart the process by pressing the Reset Aver-
age button.
You then have to define a local coordinate that you want to localize to. It is assumed that the point
exists in your Project. If it doesn't, simply double tap the Point ID field which will open the point tool-
bar. You can use the new option to create a point or if it exists select it from the map or from the list.
When you press Set Position, FieldGenius will save the averaged location into the point database. It
will then compute a one point transformation which is simply a horizontal and vertical shift from the
grid coordinate system into your local system, as well as a combined scale factor. You will be presen-
ted with the option to apply the combined scale factor at the point
- 228 -
Main Menu
l You are calculating a one point transformation and your Project coordinates are ground-level
coordinates. Please Note: No rotation will be applied and the Project North direction will be
Grid North as per your Project Coordinate System Settings.
Pick No if:
l You are calculating a transformation from multiple points and will be adding more points to the
calculation. In this case the scale parameters will be determined from the best fit to all the
points used for the transformation.
l You are calculating a one point tranformation and your Project coordinates are grid coordinates
as per your Project Coordinate System Settings.
All future GNSS measurements in the current Project will have your new transformation parameters
applied automatically.
- 229 -
Stonex FieldGenius
1. Standard Measurement
2. Offset Measurement
3. Tilt Offset Measurement
4. Auto Record Points
5. Staking
6. Local Transformation Point
7. GroupCode
8. Check Point
9. Trilateration
10. Add Invert
- 230 -
Main Menu
Standard Measurement
Main Menu or GNSS Toolbar | Measure Modes | Standard Measurement
When you have connected to your rover and you press the measure button on the GNSS Toolbar you
will see the GNSS Measurement Screen
- 231 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Once the satellites have been filtered out based on your tolerance settings, FieldGenius will only
begin collecting measurement data if all your tolerances are met. During the measurement process
you might see that certain tolerances are not being satisfied, this is normal. FieldGenius will continue
monitoring the measurement data and will accept measurements that pass the mask criteria.
Once the tolerances have been met, the position status will change to an Accepted position. Prior to
accepting the position, the user can look at the RMS values for the computed position and determine
if they wish to accept or reject the measurement. Pressing Cancel will exit the measure function
without storing any data. Pressing Store Position will accept the position and store it in the database.
You can change your true or measured Antenna Height on the Store Point screen.
By default, if you have some transformation parameters defined, they will be applied to the meas-
urement prior to storing it.
If your current tolerance settings are not met, FieldGenius can switch from Real Time mode to Post
Process mode to collect static data for that point for later post processing back in the office. This
switch from Real Time mode to Post Process mode can occur automatically or manually, depending
on your Post Process tolerance settings. The duration of the Post Process measurement is specified
in your tolerance settings, and depends on the minimum number of satellites tracked during the entire
Post Process session.
Offset Measurement
Main Menu or GNSS Toolbar | Measure Modes | Offset Measurement
FieldGenius features a GNSS offset functionality to calculate an offset from the current position
based on a direction and distance offsets. The direction may be determined from two observations.
This feature is particularly handy when a direct observation is inaccessible or there is too much can-
opy coverage to get an RTK fixed position.
Function
When this mode is enabled FieldGenius the user will press the observation button to start the routine.
After this, the GNSS Offset measurement screen as shown below will appear and is ready for the
user to press the "Start Point" button to take the first shot. Once that is done the "Start Point" button
will change to "End Point". Press this when you are on the second point and ready to take the second
observation.
- 232 -
Main Menu
After both Start and End points are observed the Direction field will now be filled with the computed
bearing between the two observed points. The next step is to manually enter in the Horizontal and Ver-
tical distances to the new offset point. Fill these fields in and press the "Measure" button to take one
more observation that will apply the computed direction, horizontal and vertical distances to the shot
and will now populate the Northing, Easting and Elevation fields of the new calculated point in the
GNSS Measurement area. The user can now press the "Store Point" button to store the calculated
point into the database.
- 233 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 234 -
Main Menu
Additional Notes
The user has the option to manually enter in the direction to the offset point if it is already known. A
vertical distance is not needed to calculate an offset point, only a Direction and a Horizontal distance
are required to complete the routine.
- 235 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 236 -
Main Menu
- 237 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The Auto Recording settings are used when collecting GNSS data in a "Kinematic" mode. The
receiver can automatically log a point every X distance or Y seconds. The user simply selects what
option they prefer to use for logging Kinematic data and start the survey. Keep in mind while collecting
data at higher velocities that FieldGenius receives position updates from the GNSS at a maximum
rate of once per second.
Once configured, Auto-Recording is activated on the Rover Measure Mode screen after pressing the
Measure button:
Once activated, Auto-Recording is deactivated by pressing the Measure button again.
Staking
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Staking
See the Staking topic for more information.
- 238 -
Main Menu
2. Measure a control point that you wish to use for your localization. You will have the choice to store
the observation as a point in the database:
3. Specify whether the control point will be used for horizontal and/or vertical control, then pick Select
Existing to set the local control point:
4. Optionally confirm the measured values for the GNSS Control Point:
- 239 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 240 -
Main Menu
GroupCode
Main Menu or GNSS Toolbar | Measure Modes | GroupCode
Overview
GroupCode is a Measure Mode that allows the user to set up a Group of Codes that have a common
theme or purpose, and is ideal to increase productivity for repetitive feature collection. GroupCode
allows:
Operation Notes
For GNSS operation there is only one GroupCode Measure Mode. The GNSS Tolerance Settings will
be honoured to determine if the observation is automatically stored:
l Auto Skip Meas Stat – This option in the Tolerance Setting determines if the measurement
statistics are displayed during the measurement process
l Auto Store Meas – This option in the Tolerance Setting determines if the Store Point dialog will
be displayed prior to storing an observation
- 241 -
Stonex FieldGenius
See the GroupCode Editor topic for information about setting up a group and changing its behaviours.
Workflow
The GroupCode feature is designed to allow fast measuring, and as such the automation of the code
selection and multiple linework figures can reduce the task to a simple measurement button press.
When no pattern is set, the user will manually need to select the next code to use, and line toggles
will be necessary for drawing arcs.
- 242 -
Main Menu
Entering Offsets
It is possible to pre-enter distance offsets that will be applied to the next measurement. The Offset
button will display the offset directions that will be applied if the offsets are set. Direction, Horizontal
Distance, and Vertical Distance.
The offset entry screen has toggles that can be used to set the values:
Check Point
Main Menu or GNSS Toolbar | Measure Modes | Check Point
Use this to measure a check shot to an existing point. When you start the command you will see the
point chooser appear where you can create a new point or pick an existing one from a list or from the
screen. After you choose your point you will be ready to measure. You will note the Measure Mode
will be set to Check Pnt and if you need to cancel the operation you can do it by pressing the Meas-
ure Mode button and choose to cancel it.
- 243 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The deltas that are displayed are computed by subtracting the shot coordinates from the known
coordinates. In other works if you add the deltas to the shot point coordinates you will end up at the
known point.
Store Point
Pressing this will exit the function and write several notes to the raw file summarizing your check
shot, and allow you to store the shot using the Store/Edit Point screen.
--Check Point
-- Check Point ID: 110
-- Check Point dNorthing: -4.59'
-- Check Point dEasting: -1.82'
-- Check Point dElevation: -4.96'
-- Check Point dHorizontal: 4.94'
-- Observed Values: HA 45°00'00.0" VA 90°00'00.0" SD 23.00' HR 5.00'
-- Observed Point Northing: 5016.26'
-- Observed Point Easting: 5016.26'
-- Observed Point Elevation: 95.00'
Close
This will exit the check shot function and not write anything to the raw file or storing a new point.
- 244 -
Main Menu
Trilateration
Main Menu or GNSS Toolbar | Measure Modes | Trilateration
This routine allows you to trilaterate the position of new points by observing their distances from two
known positions. The two known points will make up a baseline, from which a distance-distance inter-
section will be calculated to determine the position of each new point.
The primary use of this routine is for GNSS users so they can locate inaccessible points. They can
locate two points with GNSS, and then use the Trilateration routine to locate the inaccessible points.
This routine can accept distances measured with the Leica Disto.
- 245 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Save Point
This saves the selected New Point into your project.
Switch Side
This toggles the selected New Point to the Left or Right side of the baseline.
Map View
This takes you to a map view showing your baseline, the distance measured from each point, and the
calculated position of the new point.
- 246 -
Main Menu
If desired, you can press the World View button on the Display toolbar to hide unnecessary data.
Measure from Point 1
Press this to record the distance from Point 1 of your baseline to the selected New Point.
Measure from Point 2
Press this to record the distance from Point 2 of your baseline to the selected New Point.
Add Invert
Main Menu or GNSS Toolbar | Measure Modes | Add Invert
If you've manually measured a distance to an invert, you can have FieldGenius compute a point with
a computed invert elevation.
When you start the command you will see the Invert Toolbar appear towards the bottom of your main
screen.
First you need to specify the point that will be referenced to compute the invert elevation. You can do
this by using the point chooser button.
- 247 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Now enter the measured distance to the inverse. For example if your measurement was 5.5',
FieldGenius will subtract this from the reference point's elevation. Entering a negative value will
cause it to be added.
Press Store Point to create and save a point with the calculated invert distance. This point will have
the same northing and easting value as the reference point.
Note:
While the invert toolbar is open, you can continue entering invert measurements or
choose different reference points.
Raw File
When you save the point, an offset and store point record will be created.
--OS,OP7,FP8,ND0.000,ED0.000,LD5.000
SP,PN8,N 935.976,E 1232.356,EL5.000,--<No Desc>
- 248 -
Main Menu
Note: Several of these modes will not be available until you have completed a setup.
Setup and Check
Quick Setup
Use this to perform a quick setup procedure, with the instrument on a point facing a certain direction.
Please see the Quick Setup topic for more information.
Backsight by 1 Point or Direction
Use this to define an instrument setup. Same procedure as with a Total Station, please see the Back-
sight Method topic for more information.
- 249 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Resection
This will start the multiple point resection routine to allow you to determine your current instrument
position by measuring to known points. Same procedure as with a Total Station, please see the
Resection topic for more information.
Backsight Baseline
Use this to define an instrument setup from the position and orientation of an arbitrary baseline.
Please see the Backsight Baseline topic for more information.
Check Point
Use this to display a check measurement to an existing point in your Project. Same procedure as with
a Total Station, please see the Check Point topic for more information.
- 250 -
Main Menu
Offsets
Distance Offset
This will start the distance offset routine. Same procedure as with a Total Station, please see the
Distance Offset topic for more information.
- 251 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Intersections
Two Line Intersection
This allows you to measure two baselines and FieldGenius will compute the intersection point. Same
procedure as with a Total Station, please see the Two Line Intersection topic for more information.
- 252 -
Main Menu
Quick Setup
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Setup & Check | Quick Setup
This setup procedure requires a Point and a direction to complete the setup.
- 253 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Point ID
Enter a Point ID to set the Station, or tap in the field to open a menu to pick a point from a list or map,
or create a new point.
Instrument Height
Enter the height of the device above ground if you wish to reference it.
Set Direction
Enter the direction that the device is pointing, or pick on one of the four direction buttons to set the dir-
ection.
Complete Setup
Pick Complete Setup to finish. The direction will be captured and set as the orientation reference.
Backsight Baseline
Main Menu or Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Setup & Check | Backsight Baseline
When setting up a total station or Disto in a room or outside at a Scene, in certain circumstances it is
advantageous to define one of the room's walls as a baseline for the scene. Or outside to select a lin-
ear feature like a Sidewalk or curb.
- 254 -
Main Menu
Using this method ensures that your room or outside Scene coordinate system is oriented to a
baseline plane you are defining for the site. This makes the Scene easier to work in FieldGenius and
when imported into your desktop drawing program.
Another benefit to using this feature is that all points mapped with the total station will be referenced
to the origin and baseline.
Function
Usually this feature will be used in a new Project, but it could be used in an existing scene if needed.
In this example we will begin by creating a new scene.
- 255 -
Stonex FieldGenius
In the Occupy Baseline screen you need to specify the orientation of the baseline, your instrument
height and the position that you want to use for the origin point.
Baseline Direction
This is the direction that you want the wall ”baseline” to face in your Project. The direction that you
use is totally up to you. You should pick a direction that will help you visually confirm that the points
you're mapping are correct. If you refer to the image at the beginning of this document, the instrument
was setup in the lower right corner of the room. From the instrument operator's perspective, it made
sense to use a baseline set to East so the far wall would be horizontal along the X axis in the Project.
If you look at the image of the Tracker at the beginning of this topic, you will see that using this feature
makes the room align with your scene's coordinate system.
In the examples below, the same origin coordinates and total station measurement were used. The
only thing that was different, was the direction specified for the baseline.
- 256 -
Main Menu
Position of Origin
The default coordinates are 0, but any value could be used. The origin will be located and defined by
your first measurement.
Usually you will want the bottom corner of the wall to be equal to the z value you define. Assuming
you're using a reflectorless instrument, if you can't see the bottom corner directly with the instrument,
you can measure up the wall and mark a point a known distance from the floor. Then sight this point
with you instrument, but make sure you define the distance you measured as your new target height.
Otherwise, if no target height is specified, the location you measure at the corner will be the origin.
Measure Baseline
When you press this you will be required to measure two shots; one to define the origin and the other
to define the location of the instrument in reference to the baseline.
How it Works
Using the origin, and the baseline direction you specified, a ”baseline” is created.
- 257 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Using the first shot, the instrument position cannot be accurate calculated yet. The instrument isn't
referenced to the baseline yet, and hinges around the origin point.
Then using the second shot, the total station location in the room can be accurately computed.
- 258 -
Main Menu
You will now see that the Occupy Inst screen is enabled. Press this to accept your measurements
and FieldGenius will store a new point for the reference point. Also, in the raw file Occupy point
records will be recorded along with the measurements made on the wall.
--Occupy Room
--Baseline Direction: East
--N 0.0000,E 0.0000,EL0.0000,--Origin Pnt
--HI1.310,HR1.514,AR25.16100,ZE88.26290,SD7.0790,--Pnt for Origin
--HI1.310,HR1.514,AR63.18170,ZE88.26220,SD5.1750,--Pnt on Baseline
OC,OP1,N -5.1514,E 4.8516,EL0.0115,--RP
BK,OP1,BP0,BS316.42594,BC25.16100
LS,HI1.310,HR1.514
You are now ready to continue mapping your scene.
- 259 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Survey Tools
Main Menu | Survey Tools
This menu contains functions pertaining to the data in your Project.
Store Points
Use this to enter new coordinates into your scene's database. Please see the Store Points topic for
more information.
Drawing Tool
This starts up the draw plan tool.
Delete Last Saved Point
Use this to "delete" up to ten of the last points that were saved. Please see the Delete Last Saved
Point topic for more information.
Raw File Viewer
Use this to open a viewer that will display your current raw file. Please see the Raw File Viewer topic
for more information.
COGO History Viewer
Use this to display the results that were computed using the COGO commands. Please see the
COGO History Viewer topic for more information.
- 260 -
Main Menu
Traverse Report
Use this to generate a traverse closure report based on your traverse setups. Please see the Tra-
verse Report topic for more information.
GNSS Local Transformation
Use this to specify transformation parameters that can be used to localize GNSS data. Please see
the Transformation Setup topic for more information.
Bolt Pattern
Use this to create and apply point patterns for example for bolt plates or pillars. Please see the Bolt
Pattern topic for more information.
Add Raw File Note
Use this to add a comment to the raw file. Please see the Raw File Comment topic for more inform-
ation.
View Averaged Points
Please see the Point Averaging topic for more information.
- 261 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Point ID
Enter in the point number you would like to assign to the point. Note that by default it will display the
next available point number. If you're editing an existing point, this field will not be editable.
Line/Spline/Arc Buttons
This is used to toggle on and off the draw lines function. When turned on as you
shoot your points in the drawing they will be connected with a line. This button can
only be used if you're storing a point after a measurement.
This is used to toggle on and off the draw curvy lines button. This function will
draw a best-fit curve through your points as you shoot them. This button can only
be used if you're storing a point after a measurement.
3-Point arcs can be started using the same method as for a Line or Curvy Line.
This button can only be used if you're storing a point after a measurement.
- 262 -
Main Menu
Description
This is where you can enter a description for your point. This field is associated with your AutoMap lib-
rary so as soon as you start typing in descriptions, a list appears displaying descriptions that match
what you've entered. Simply press your Enter Key to accept your entry. You can also have
FieldGenius notify you when the description you've entered isn't in your AutoMap library. To do this
you need to make sure you have the New Description Prompt toggle turned on in the Options menu.
List Button
Press this to open the AutoMap Library screen. You will be able to choose the description that will be
assigned to the point.
Northing, Easting, Elevation
Input your coordinate values in these fields when manually creating a new point using the add point
function. If measuring a point, you cannot manually enter or edit coordinates.
Note Button
Press this to enter a note or record an audio note for the point. See the Notes topic for more inform-
ation.
Prism Hgt (Height) / GNSS Hgt (Height)
When storing a point measured by a total station, you can set the Prism Height. When storing a point
measured by a GNSS receiver, you can set the true or measured Antenna Height.
Review Measurement Button
This button is available when you have taken a measurement, and can be used to review the distance
and angles measured.
GIS Attributes Button
If you loaded a feature list, then this button will be enabled. It allows you to access your feature list so
you can edit feature attributes.
Store Pnt (point) Button
Press this to store the measured point.
Store SS (side shot) Button
Press this to store the point as a side shot. You would typically use this when not measuring traverse
points. You will not see this button when measuring with GNSS.
Store TR (traverse) Button
Press this to store the point as a traverse point. You would typically use this when the measured point
belongs to a traverse. You will not see this button when measuring with GNSS.
- 263 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Cancel Button
Press this to cancel the measurement.
Advanced Button
Use this button to add or edit advanced tags to your point. You will mainly use this to help you dis-
tinguish points that are exported when you use the XML export.
Survey Role: Use this to edit the survey role for the point. By default points that are measured will
have a role of Measured. Points with a Measured role type are read only when they're viewed with
the store and edit screen. If you export an XML file, this information will be exported.
DTM State: Use this to choose the DTM attribute that will be written to the database file. Determine
By Feature is the default value, if you don't want the point used in FieldGenius's modeling com-
mands, you can set the DTM value to Do not Include. If you export an XML file, this information will
be exported.
Point Type: Use this to enter a point type that will be written to the database file. If you export an
XML file, this information will be exported.
Geometry: Use this to enter a geometry type that will be written to the database file. If you export an
XML file, this information will be exported.
Zone: Use this to enter a zone number that will be written to the database file. If you export an XML
file, this information will be exported.
- 264 -
Main Menu
Drawing Tool
Main Menu | Survey Tools | Drawing Tool
Line Toolbar | Pencil button
Point Toolbar | Pencil button
This tool allows you to quickly draw a plan such as a pad or a building footprint into your Project, and
is typically used to recreate plans from a paper hard-copy. You can use this to either calculate new
points, or to connect existing points that are already in your Project.
You must have at least one point in your Project before you can start, to define the starting position for
your plan. If a point does not yet exist (for example if this is the first command you run in a new Pro-
ject), you will be prompted to store a new point before you can proceed.
Line Mode
Use the Line draw mode to add straight line segments to your figure.
Start Point
Specify the start point for the new segment.
For starting a new plan, this should be set to an existing point in your Project, typically a corner that
you will begin drawing the plan from.
As you continue adding subsequent points/segments to your plan, you will see the Start Point field
automatically advance for you.
- 265 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Distance
Specify the length of the line segment you wish to draw.
Direction
Specify the direction (Azimuth or Bearing) of the line segment you wish to draw. The easiest way to
do this is to use the right/left arrow buttons, which will increment/decrement the direction value by the
amount shown in the pulldown list below the arrows. You can select a common angle from the
choices in the list (90, 45, or 30 degrees), or you can type any value if you need to increment it by
some other amount.
Store
After you have defined the segment to add, press this to store the new point and line segment into
your Project.
Store+
This does the same as the Store button, but you will see the Store/Edit Point screen. Use this to con-
firm or view the coordinates, or to specify a description.
Point by Line Mode
This is the same as the Line mode, except that when you press Store or Store+ it will only store the
point, without drawing the line segment.
Arc Mode
Use the Arc draw mode to add arc segments to your figure.
- 266 -
Main Menu
Start Point
Specify the start point for the new segment.
For starting a new plan, this should be set to an existing point in your Project, typically a corner that
you will begin drawing the plan from.
As you continue adding subsequent points/segments to your plan, you will see the Start Point field
automatically advance for you.
Direction
Specify the direction (Azimuth or Bearing) of the tangent in to the arc segment you wish to draw.
This will default to either the direction of the previous line segment or the tangent out of the previous
arc segment, so as long as your arc is tangential to the previous segment you will not need to change
this value.
Angle / Chord Length / Arc Length
Specify one of the three available methods to define your arc:
Radius
Specify the radius to define your arc.
Clockwise / Counter-Clockwise Arrows
Use the Right/Left arrow buttons to define whether the arc rotates clockwise or counter-clockwise.
Store
After you have defined the segment to add, press this to store the new end and radial points, and draw
the arc segment into your Project.
Store+
This does the same as the Store button, but you will see the Store/Edit Point screen. Use this to con-
firm or view the coordinates, or to specify a description.
Point by Arc Mode
This is the same as the Arc mode, except that when you press Store or Store+ it will only store the
points, without drawing the arc segment.
Connect Points Mode
This mode lets you draw lines/arcs by connecting points that already exist in your Project.
- 267 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Start Point
Specify the start point for the new segment.
For starting a new plan, this should be set to an existing point in your Project, typically a corner that
you will begin drawing the plan from.
As you continue connecting subsequent points to your plan, you will see the Start Point field auto-
matically advance for you.
Line Type
Specify one of the five available methods to define your next figure segment:
l Straight: this will draw a straight line between the specified Start Point and End Point.
l Arc (CW): this will draw a clockwise arc between the specified Start Point and End Point, with
the specified Radial Point.
l Arc (CCW): this will draw a counter-clockwise arc between the specified Start Point and End
Point, with the specified Radial Point.
l Arc (3Pnt): this will draw an arc (clockwise or counter-clockwise) between the specified Start
Point and End Point, going through the specified intermediate Arc Point (any point directly on
the arc, does not need to be the midpoint).
l Spline: this will draw a curvy line between the specified Start Point and End Point.
- 268 -
Main Menu
Store / Store+
The Store and Store+ buttons are disabled for this mode, because new points are not being calculated
for your Project. The line or arc segment will be automatically drawn into your Project after you spe-
cify its parameters.
Undo
Press the Undo button to undo the last segment you computed, removing both the point and/or the
line segment (as appropriate) from your Project. You can undo multiple steps.
Note, there is no Redo function.
Close
Press the Close button to exit from the Draw Plan command, and you will be returned to the map
screen.
- 269 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Use this button to open the raw file viewer. The raw file editor displays your scene's raw file and
allows you to review it in an easy to read grid. For reference on the different raw file record types that
FieldGenius uses you can refer to the Raw File Record Types topic for more information.
Edit Record
To edit a record simply tap the line in the raw file that has the record you want to edit. Then tap on the
edit button to start editing the record.
- 270 -
Main Menu
Save Changes: When you press the Save Changes button you will see the Raw File Edit screen
which shows you the changes that will be made when you press the Yes button. Press No to cancel.
After you press yes, the record will be changed and we will also write the original one to the raw file as
a comment and it will be prefixed with the word "Edited".
Undo Changes: Undo will ignore your changes and return them to the original values.
Insert LS Record
The most common modification to the raw file is to insert a LS record. The LS record will be inserted
above the highlighted row and a comment will be written as well to indicate that it was inserted.
Insert Note Record
This will allow you to enter a comment. The comment will be inserted above the current line you have
highlighted in the grid.
Append Note Record
This will allow you to enter a comment. The comment will be appended to the end of the raw file.
Reprocess File
After you have made your changes you can re-coordinate the raw file so the changes are displayed on
the screen and saved in the project database.
Note:
When you re-coordinate the raw file it will process the whole file from beginning to
end. This means if you have changed the coordinate information for a point there is a
chance that it will be changed back to its original value if it was measured and recor-
ded in the raw file.
Show Map
This will change the raw file viewer to a split-screen display with a map view of your scene on half of
the screen. When certain raw file records are selected, you will be shown the reference and backsight
points, and the selected measurement record will be highlighted on the map.
- 271 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 272 -
Main Menu
Both the Traverse / Intersect and Inverse commands will save information to this file, as well as
Areas, Volumes, and various other calculations.
The size of the text can be set to normal or large using the "Use large info text" option in the program
settings.
Traverse Report
Main Menu | Survey Tools | Traverse Report
Use this to compute a traverse closure based on traverse points you've measured and recorded. The
traverse report scans your raw file for traverse records, which appear with a TR record type. You can
save your shot as a TR record by choosing the TR button when the Measurement Info screen
appears. TR records are also useful when you use the Setup Occupy Point function because your
last TR shot will now become the current setup point and the BS point will be set to the last setup
point for you automatically.
You can also balance your traverse using an angle, compass and vertical balance routine. See the
Traverse Adjustment topic for more information.
The following examples will show you the traverse scenarios that FieldGenius supports. The open tri-
angles depict known or computed points. TR records indicate all the foresight shots that were meas-
ured and recorded, and the OC record indicate the points that were occupied. Finally, the BK record
indicates the point that was used for the initial backsight.
- 273 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 274 -
Main Menu
FieldGenius will automatically scan the raw file looking for the last TR foresight and the OC record
that was used to measure the last foresight. It will then search for any point within a 3 meter radius
and use it as the match or point that defines the original coordinates.
If more than one point is found in the 3 meter radius, it will use the one that is closest.
FieldGenius supports two closed traverse methods. Choose Foresight Point Closes Traverse if
you want to do a "Text Book" traverse closure. If you choose the Occupy Point Closes Traverse
method, FieldGenius will not use your last foresight observation and assumes that the original back-
sight and occupy points are fixed. Choosing this method will close the traverse on the original back-
sight point, not the original setup point.
When you press the View Report button you will see the traverse closure results.
- 275 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Total length
This is the total unknown legs that were measured in the field.
Segments
This is the total length traversed. Only unknown traverse legs will be added.
Horizontal Error
This is the horizontal closure and precision for your traverse. The closure direction is calculated from
the known point to your measured point. If there isn't enough data to compute the angular error you
will see the word "No Comparison" It also displays the delta northing and easting differences.
Vertical Error
This is the vertical error that is computed by comparing the elevations of the known point and meas-
ured closing point.
Traverse Definition (Foresight Method Bearing)
If we use CASE 3 as an example the user first setup on point 1 and backsighted point 2. He then
foresighted and setup on points 3 to 6 and closed the traverse by recording one more TR record to
point 7. To compute the traverse report you go to the Main Menu / Survey and choose the Traverse
Report button. When selected, you will see the following screen.
- 276 -
Main Menu
FieldGenius will automatically scan the raw file looking for the last TR foresight and the OC record
that was used to measure the last foresight. It will then search for any point within a 3 meter radius
and use it as the match or point that defines the original coordinates. If more than one point is found in
the 3 meter radius, it will use the one that is closest. In the Foresight Bearing field, enter in a known
Bearing. When you press the View Report button you will see the traverse closure results.
Raw File
Several comments will be written to the raw file with the traverse report results for both Traverse
Definition types.
--Traverse Report
-- Total Length: 600.10'
-- Segments: 3
-- Foresight control point: 1
-- Occupy control point: 2
-- Horizontal Distance Error: 0.10' 286°13'38"
-- Horizontal Angular Error: 0°00'30"
-- Horizontal Precision: 1:5762
-- Vertical Distance Error: 0.00'
-- Vertical Precision: No Error
- 277 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Traverse Adjustment
Main Menu | Survey Tools | Traverse Report
FieldGenius is capable of performing a traverse balance. You can adjust the traverse using a vertical,
angle or compass balance. You can select any one of the three adjustment types or apply all three of
them to the traverse.
The traverse routine uses traverse TR records in the raw file to define the traverse points that will be
used for the adjustment. Please refer to the Traverse Report topic for more information on creating a
traverse loop with FieldGenius.
When FieldGenius computes an adjustment it will write to the RAW file AP records with the new cal-
culated coordinates for the traverse points.
FieldGenius will adjust the sideshots after you perform an adjustment. FieldGenius will scan the raw
file from the beginning and re-process all setups (OC records) and sideshots (SS records).
- 278 -
Main Menu
Once you have completed your traverse and you would like to adjust it you need to do the following.
- 279 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 280 -
Main Menu
- 281 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 282 -
Main Menu
Vertical Transformation
The vertical transformation function of FieldGenius operates independently of the horizontal trans-
formation. A sloped plane is calculated from the residuals of the constrained point pairs to determine a
vertical bias, slope in X and slope in Y. To determine a vertical bias at least one point pair must be con-
strained and for all three parameters to be determined at least three point pairs must be constrained.
The use of the vertical transformation function should be restricted to cases where a geoid model is
not available or there is a known problem with an existing geoid model.
Transformation Setup
Main Menu | Survey Tools | GNSS Local Transformation
Starting a new transformation, the following options will be available:
Modify Parameters
The Modify Parameters page allows the user to set the transformation method and parameters. This
is always the first step of any local transformation. See the Modify Parameters topic for more inform-
ation.
Import Parameters
FieldGenius has the ability to read in a localization file (*.loc) to apply a previously used trans-
formation to the current Project. Select this button and navigate to the desired .loc file to load it in.
There is no need to export the .loc file as it is automatically updated during the transformation routine.
- 283 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Reset Parameters
Use this option to reset any previously applied transformation parameters. This cannot be undone.
NOTE: Depending on what the user specifies at the "Modify Parameters" page, additional options
may become available:
Modify Control
Only applicable for a "Similarity" method where the parameters are calculated by matching up control
points. This option can be used to add, edit or delete control pairs used for the calculation of the trans-
formation parameters. See the Modify Control topic for more information.
Adjust GNSS Points
When the transformation parameters are finalized, this option can be used to update the coordinates
of every GNSS measured point in the database. The transformation parameters are always applied to
the original Lat/Long of the measured point, to compute the adjusted grid coordinates.
Modify Parameters
Main Menu | Survey Tools | GNSS Local Transformation | Modify Parameters
The first step of a transformation is to specify the method to use: None, Similarity or Helmert.
Depending on your selection, different input will be required.
- 284 -
Main Menu
None
For this method, the only input required are the Scale Parameters.
Similarity Method
Similarity transformation parameters can be calculated from control points, or manually defined:
- 285 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Helmert Method
This method allows the user to manually enter the 7 Parameters of a Helmert Transformation (Trans-
lation X, Y and Z, Rotation X, Y, and Z, and Scale). These parameters will usually be pre-computed
and/or published.
- 286 -
Main Menu
Scale Parameters
The Scale Parameters can be:
1. User Defined - Manually enter the Grid Factor and Elevation Factor to determine the Com-
bined Factor.
2. Select From Database - Pick a point from the database that was already measured with
GNSS and stored. The Combined Factor of the point will be calculated.
3. Measure GNSS Position - Use the current position of the rover to calculate a Combined
Factor.
NOTE:
In all cases the entered or calculated Combined Factor will be the inverse of the Com-
bined Factor typically seen published or otherwise calculated.
The standard expression of the typical Combined Factor is:
Grid Distance = Ground Distance * Combined Factor.
We can refer to this as the "Ground to Grid" factor.
FieldGenius expects the "Grid to Ground" Combined Factor, which is the inverse of
the typical Combined Factor.
NOTE: The transformation parameters are immediately applied to your current position and written to
the Project's *.loc file when you confirm the values with OK.
- 287 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Modify Control
Main Menu | Survey Tools | GNSS Local Transformation | Modify Control
Use this option to Add, Edit and Delete control points used to calculate the Similarity Transformation
parameters.
Add Control
Pick Add Control to match a Local Control point with a GNSS Control point. Control points can be
matched 1D, 2D or 3D.
- 288 -
Main Menu
l The Local Control section only allows the user to select an existing point from the database.
l The GNSS Control section allows the user to select an existing point from the database (must
have been previously measured with GNSS) or to measure a position which can then option-
ally be added to the database.
- 289 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Edit Control
Select a row and then pick Edit Control to modify any component of a matched pair. For example,
after reviewing the residuals of all the control points, it may be necessary to change a 3D match to a
2D match. The calculated parameters are immediately updated.
Delete Control
Select a row and then pick Delete Control to completely remove a control pair from the list. The cal-
culated parameters are immediately updated.
Continue to add/edit/delete control until you are satisfied with the residuals. When done; press the
OK button to take you back to the main GNSS Local Transformation dialog.
NOTE: The transformation parameters are immediately applied to your current postion and written to
the Project's *.loc file when you confirm the values with OK.
To complete the transformation and update previously measured GNSS points, pick the Adjust
GNSS Points option.
- 290 -
Main Menu
Bolt Patterns
Main Menu | Survey Tools | Bolt Pattern
This routine allows you to create or edit point patterns, and apply them to existing points in your pro-
ject. This is useful for creating drill holes for bolt patterns, pillar columns, etc.
Note
The *.pattern data files are completely interchangeable between both FieldGenius and
Stonex Geomatics CAD, so any patterns created in one program can be edited or
used in the other.
Pattern Toolbar
When you start the Point Pattern command, you will see the Pattern Toolbar along the bottom of your
map screen.
- 291 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Insert Pnt
Specify the point ID for an existing point in your project, either by typing in its point ID, or by tapping
on a point in the map screen to select it when this field has focus.
The selected point will be highlighted in the map view with a large red point, and the current pattern
will be previewed with smaller green points.
Direction
Use this to specify a direction value for your pattern. The default direction of N0°00'00"E will orient
the pattern exactly as it was defined.
To orient your pattern along any arbitrary line between two existing points, enter those two points
using the pt#..pt# format like 1..2 and the direction between those two points will be automatically cal-
culated for you. The pattern's X-axis will be applied along this direction.
Load Pattern
Press this button to load a previously saved *.pattern file.
Edit Pattern
Press this button to edit the currently loaded pattern, or to create a new pattern if you have not loaded
one. Please see below for more information on the Pattern Editor.
- 292 -
Main Menu
Insert Pattern
Press this button to apply the currently pattern to the selected insertion point. New points will be
stored in your project at the coordinates, as previewed by the green pattern points. All inserted points
will be created with the description "Pattern", and with the same elevation as the selected insertion
point.
To insert a pattern onto multiple points, simply change the insertion point and insert the pattern onto
each point one-at-a-time as desired.
Pattern Editor
When you press Edit Pattern on the Pattern Toolbar, you will see the Pattern Editor screen.
Enter the X and Y offset values for your pattern as desired. As you enter the points, they will be pre-
viewed in the grid, which will automatically zoom to the extents of your pattern. Please see the
Distance Entry & Recall topic for options on entering the offset values in various units.
The 0,0 origin will always be located at the selected Insertion Point, so a point should not be included
in your pattern at 0,0. You can also rotate the pattern into any orientation on the Pattern Toolbar (see
above), so you do not need to create different variations of the same pattern to insert it in different ori-
entations.
Press the Delete Point button to remove the selected X,Y offset from the pattern.
Load Pattern
Press this button to load a previously saved *.pattern file.
- 293 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Save Pattern
Press this button to save the current pattern to disk.
This will always do a "Save As" type save, so you can specify a new filename, or select any existing
pattern file to overwrite it with the changes. You will always be prompted for confirmation before over-
writing an existing pattern file.
New Pattern
To create a new pattern, simply delete all of the existing points from the current pattern. When you
press the Save Pattern button you will always be prompted for a new filename, so you will not lose
the previous pattern.
Close
Press this button to close the Pattern Editor and return to the Pattern Toolbar. If you have not saved
the current pattern, you will be prompted to confirm this before discarding your changes.
If you view your raw file your comments will appear as shown in the following example.
- 294 -
Main Menu
--This is a comment
You can also enter comments into the raw file by using the Raw File Viewer.
- 295 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Calculations
Main Menu | Calculations
The calculation menu contains calculation based functions that can be used to compute points, lines
and other data.
Inverse
Use this to inverse between points. Please see the Inverse topic for more information.
Traverse / Intersection
This will open the Traverse / Intersect toolbar. You can enter in directions and distances and perform
common intersections such as bearing / bearing, distance/distance and many more. Please see the
Traverse / Intersection topic for more information.
Offset Intersection
Use this to compute points that are located at computed intersections and offsets. This is essentially
a bearing-bearing intersection, but you can specify offsets. Please see the Offset Intersection topic
for more information.
Station / Offset
Use this to compute points at pre-defined stations and offsets. You can also use this to display the
station and offset of existing points. Please see the Station / Offset topic for more information.
- 296 -
Main Menu
Inverse
Main Menu | Calculations | Inverse
This command will calculate for you the inverse between two points. It will display the horizontal /
slope distance, direction, vertical distance and slope between the two points. You do not need to
have a line drawn between the points to use the inverse command.
- 297 -
Stonex FieldGenius
A large font can be set for the results toolbar and COGO results. Please refer to the Options topic for
more information.
All Inverse information is saved in the COGO History file called CogoCalcs.txt located in your Project
folder. Please refer to the COGO History Viewer topic for more information.
Traverse Inverse
Function
1. Start the inverse command and make sure the Traverse Inverse and Line options are selec-
ted.
2. Enter or choose the first point to calculate from, and press your enter key to continue on to the
next point.
3. Now you can choose or enter the second point and press your Enter button to compute an
answer.
4. The inverse information will be displayed in the results toolbar.
5. In the COGO history you will see the following information for the two points:
-------------------------------
INVERSE
-------------------------------
PNT 44 to 8 (HD 1352.84' @ NA 323°48'03.1") SD 1353.39' GR -2.85' VD -
38.51' AR 323°48'03.1"
Your first inverse will calculate a right angle from north to the direction you inversed.
Multiple Lines
After you have specified two points, you can continue inversing from point to point. You should notice
that the point id previously in the 2nd point field will move to the 1st point field, and the cursor will
remain in the 2nd point field allowing you to quickly enter in your next point.
If you continue inversing from point to point, the angle right will not be referenced to north, but the last
leg you inversed. Essentially this is computing a clockwise angle between the current and last legs
you inverse.
Perimeter Distance and Area
If you close back to the first point, a perimeter distance and enclosed area will also be computed.
Radial Inverse
You can compute radial inverses from a point.
- 298 -
Main Menu
Function
1. Start the inverse command and make sure the Radial Inverse and Line options are selected.
2. Enter or choose the 1st point to calculate from, and press your enter key to continue on to the
next point.
3. Now you can choose or enter the 2nd point and press your Enter button to compute an answer.
4. The inverse information will be displayed in the results toolbar.
5. You can now continue computing radial inverses. The 2nd point field will remain activated
allowing you to continue entering point numbers.
Radial Arc
You can compute the curve information for an arc defined by three points, PC (start), Radius Point,
and PT (End)
Function
1. Start the inverse command and make sure the Rad Arc button is turned on.
2. Enter or choose the starting point for the arc in the Start field, and press your enter key to con-
tinue on to the next point.
3. Enter or choose the radius point in the Arc field, and press your enter key to continue on to the
next point.
4. Enter or choose the end point for the arc in the End field, and press your enter key to compute
an answer.
5. The inverse information will be displayed in the results toolbar.
- 299 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Function
1. Start the inverse command and make sure the 3 Pt Arc button is turned on.
2. Enter or choose the starting point for the arc in the Start field, and press your enter key to con-
tinue on to the next point.
3. Enter or choose the point that falls on the arc in the Arc field, and press your enter key to con-
tinue on to the next point.
4. Enter or choose the end point for the arc in the End field, and press your enter key to compute
an answer.
5. The inverse information will be displayed in the results toolbar.
Traverse / Intersection
Main Menu | Calculations | Traverse / Intersection
FieldGenius includes a powerful COGO function that allows you to compute new points. The toolbar
allows you to specify the solution type, point numbers, directions and distances. When you enter
enough information to compute a solution it will be draw visually on the screen. Pressing the Store
Pnt button will store the point that you just solved.
Input
You can type in the point ID, or select a point by tapping on the map screen.
The direction and distance fields support the direction and distance recall features.
If you are measuring distances with a Leica Disto, just double tap in the distance field and choose the
"Disto Observation" option.
Disto Distances
If you have a Leica Disto, you can send distances back to the distance edit fields. Simply double tap
the distance field and select "Disto Observation" which will then set FieldGenius in a "waiting" mode.
Take the measurement with the Disto, press the Bluetooth icon on the Disto, and the measured dis-
tance will be accepted by FieldGenius.
Calculator
You can open our calculator by double-tapping the Direction or Distance fields then pressing Cal-
culator on the Keypad screen.
Information
You can review the results of your calculation by pressing the "i" information button. For intersections
with multiple solutions, the results of both solutions will be displayed.
- 300 -
Main Menu
Solution Methods
Method: Traverse
The traverse method allows you to define a direction and distance that you want to traverse. After you
solve your point and store it, it will become the new start point.
- 301 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 302 -
Main Menu
- 303 -
Stonex FieldGenius
COGO Results
Every calculation you make is written to the file called CogoCalcs.txt located in your Project folder.
Please see the COGO History Viewer topic for more information.
Offset Intersection
Main Menu | Calculations | Offset Intersection
Use this function to compute a point at specified offsets from an implied bearing-bearing intersection
calculated from two existing points as shown.
- 304 -
Main Menu
When you start the command you will see the offset intersection toolbar appear towards the bottom of
the main interface. Use the point chooser to select the points that you want to use to define your dir-
ections. Offsets are computed positive to the right and negative to the left looking in the direction of
the bearing you entered. You can use angle and distance recall features to help you compute your
answer.
Function
1. Use the point chooser to select a point or manually type one in that defines the beginning of the
bearing.
2. Enter a direction in the Angle/Dir field.
3. Enter an offset if needed. You are not required to enter an offset so the field can be left blank.
4. Repeat for the second point the first three steps.
5. Press the green checkmark to save your point. It will save the point using the Store / Edit
Points function.
Station/Offset
Main Menu | Calculations | Station/Offset
This routine allows you to calculate and draw points and/or figures, offset from other existing points,
figures, or DXF entities in your project. You can calculate points on a line or down and out from a line,
or offset complete figures.
- 305 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Selection Mode
Press the "Select Line" button to go into Selection Mode. You will also automatically go into Selection
Mode if a line is not yet selected when you start this command.
Whichever Selection Mode you use, the selected line will be highlighted in red in the map screen
along with a direction indicator. If necessary, you can press the Switch Direction button to reverse
the start and end of the selected line. Press OK to accept the selected line and proceed to the next
step.
Selection Mode: Figure/DXF
Pick this mode to select an existing figure or DXF entity by selecting the desired figure from the map
screen. You can select any of the following:
- 306 -
Main Menu
After selecting a line using any of the above Selection Modes, pick this mode and enter the Sta-
tion/Offset distances and the offset direction (left or right, looking down the line).
The calculated point will be previewed in green in the map screen. Press the Save button to store this
point.
Station Point Mode
Use this mode to calculate the Down and Out distances to a selected point, and to calculate a per-
pendicular intersection point on the selected line.
- 307 -
Stonex FieldGenius
After selecting a line using any of the above Selection Modes, pick this mode and select the Offset
Point by either typing in its Point ID or by selecting it from the map screen when the Offset Pnt field
has focus.
The selected point will be highlighted in red in the map screen, and its Station/Offset distances from
the selected line will be displayed.
A perpendicular intersection point on the line will be calculated and previewed in green in the map
screen. Press the Save button to store this point.
Line Mode
Use this mode to draw a new line or figure, offset from the selected line.
- 308 -
Main Menu
After selecting a line using any of the above Selection Modes, pick this mode and enter the distance
and direction (left or right looking down the line, or both sides).
The offset line will be calculated and previewed in green in the map screen. Press the Save button to
store this line. When a line is saved, points will be automatically stored at the start and end points, arc
radial points if applicable, and polyline vertex points if applicable.
Rotate/Translate/Scale Points
Apply User Defined Parameters
Main Menu | Calculations | Rotate/Translate/Scale | Apply User Defined Parameters
Use this to rotate, translate and scale a point or group of points by entering the parameters. When this
command is used notes will automatically be written to the raw file indicating what parameters were
entered by the user. Coordinates that are updated with the RTS command will be recorded in the raw
file with AP (Adjusted Points) records.
The RTS command has the three options located on separate screens. The user can specify more
than one option at the same time, for example you could rotate a group of points by 45° CW, then
translate them 25' east. This can be done in one operation, instead of two separate ones.
All of the fields have extended edit functionality. On the direction or distance fields, if you double tap
them you will see a popup menu. From there you can start the calculator or use the inverse command.
When using the inverse option, simply type the two numbers for the inverse, then press the ESC key
to automatically copy the value that was computed during the inverse.
- 309 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The RTS function can also be accessed from the coordinate database. Accessing it from there allows
you to select your points form the list which in some cases might be easier than entering a point
range.
Rotate: Simple Angle
This is the simplest form of rotating your points. Specify the base point for the rotation, and a rotation
angle.
- 310 -
Main Menu
- 311 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 312 -
Main Menu
- 313 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 314 -
Main Menu
Confirm the Control type (2D or 3D, or none) by selecting the “Apply Horizontal” and “Apply Vertical”
checkbox options. Pick the “Select” option for Source Control Point selection and Destination Control
Point selection. The standard Point Picker tool is opened to enter or select the point.
Editing Control
Select a control pair, then pick “Edit Control” to edit the control pair. The resulting dialog allows the
user to modify any of the parameters of the control pair.
- 315 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Deleting Control
Select a control pair, then pick “Delete Control” to delete the control pair. A confirmation screen is
presented.
- 316 -
Main Menu
Resetting Control
Pick “Reset Control” to remove all control pairs. A confirmation screen is presented.
- 317 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 318 -
Main Menu
Adjusting Points
Pick “Adjust Points” to apply the calculated parameters to points in the project. The Point Selection
dialog allows the user to pick the option to transform points measured with total station. This option
will scan the raw file to extract all Point IDs that were observed with a total station. In addition (or
instead), the user can enter the point(s) to be transformed.
- 319 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 320 -
Main Menu
Additional Notes
1. From the main “Transformation Control” screen, the OK menu option will save the current
state of the entered parameters and then exit to the Map Screen. The Cancel menu option will
not save any changes made since the current instance of the routine was started.
2. The program saves the values of the point coordinates at the time they were added as control.
After points have been adjusted, the parameters that are stored will not be updated with the
new coordinates, and as such they can become “stale”. This is to allow transforming additional
points with the original parameters. When point coordinates have changed, the program will
alert the user of the modified coordinates. If additional control will be added to re-calculate a
transformation, it is best to use the “Reset Control” option and re-add all the control pairs.
Curve Calculator
Main Menu | Calculations | Curve Calculator
FieldGenius includes a curve calculator that can be used to check curve data and also compute and
curve points.
- 321 -
Stonex FieldGenius
1. You always have to define the direction for the curve, either right or left.
2. Enter your know values.
3. If you want to store points, you need to define the PC point. You can enter the point id or use
the point chooser.
4. You also need to define the PC Tangent direction, so FieldGenius knows the orientation of the
curve.
Store Points
Once you have computed your curve data, you have the option of storing the PT and Center points.
When you press either button you will see the store and edit screen.
- 322 -
Main Menu
Area Calculator
Main Menu | Calculations | Area Calculator
The area calculator is used to compute areas as well as predetermined areas.
When defining the boundary area, you can select points, lines and arcs from the map, or type the
point numbers in manually. Lines and points from DXF files are also valid and can be selected using
the Define Area toolbar.
Defining an Area
Define Area Toolbar (Points)
Select Point
The define area toolbar is used to help you define an area. If the first button is set to Select Point, the
toolbar is in "point selection" mode and will only accept points picked from the map or point numbers
that are typed in. This button acts as a toggle and will toggle between Select Point and Select Line.
Line
If you are defining a straight segment, then you should leave the Line button turned on. Simply select
two points from the map, or enter the point numbers manually.
Rad Arc
Use this to define a curved segment where you know the start, radius, and end points. You need to
first pick the start of the arc, then press the Rad Arc button to define the radius point. After doing so,
the program will automatically switch back to the Line segment type which at that time you should
select the end of the arc.
3 Pnt Arc
Use this to define a curved segment where you know three points on the arc. You need to first pick
the start of the arc, then press the 3 Pnt Arc button which will allow you to define two more points on
the arc for a total of three points. The program will automatically switch back to the Line segment type
after the third point is selected.
Remove Previous
Use this to remove segments that were defined for the area boundary. This will remove the segments
one at a time starting with the last segment that was defined.
- 323 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Select Line
The define area toolbar is used to help you define an area. If the first button is set to Select Line, the
toolbar is in "line selection" mode and will only accept lines picked from the map. This button acts as
a toggle and will toggle between Select Point and Select Line.
Switch Direction
Since this routine accepts FieldGenius figures as well as DXF entities, at times you need to switch
the direction of a DXF line so that it matches the direction that you are traversing around to define the
area boundary. As you select lines from the map you will see a red marker appear at the end of the
line.
Remove Previous
Use this to remove segments that were defined for the area boundary. This will remove the segments
one at a time starting with the last segment that was defined.
Enclosed Area Calculation
To compute an area you need to make sure you have the Calculate Area tab selected. You can then
press the Define Area button to define the boundary that will outline the area perimeter. It is import-
ant to note that you are not required to "close" the area by selecting the original starting point.
- 324 -
Main Menu
The green marker indicates the start of the area perimeter, whereas the red marker indicates the last
point on the perimeter. When ready to compute the area, simple press the exit button (red X) on the
Define Area toolbar.
- 325 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The Parallel Method helps you compute the location of a new boundary using a user entered direction,
usually parallel to one of the fixed sides.
Hinge Method
The first thing you need to do when using the hinge method is define the fixed sides of your boundary.
Once you do this, on the determine area screen you can enter the predetermined area amount you
want to compute a solution for, plus define what point is fixed and is to be used as the hinge point.
The start and finish points (markers) are represented using a green and red circle marker. You can
always press world button on the Display toolbar which will place text labels next to the start and fin-
ish points.
- 326 -
Main Menu
- 327 -
Stonex FieldGenius
FieldGenius will compute the new boundary so that it intersects the boundary segments con-
nected to the start and finish points that were defined.
In the example below, the original left side of the lot now has two segments that define it. In this
example, the solution would have to intersect the boundary segments from (108 - 9001). If we use the
same predetermined area parameters as above, FieldGenius will not be able to compute a solution
because the solution does not intersect the segment between (108 - 9001). It actually would intersect
the line from (9001 – 109).
- 328 -
Main Menu
However if we increase the predetermined area amount from 10000 to 12000, a solution can be com-
puted because the solution can now intersect the segment between point 108 and 9001. If you did
want to use an amount of 10000, all you would need to do is change the start point from 108 to 9001.
Parallel Method
The first thing you need to do is define the fixed sides for your area. It is important to note that
FieldGenius will try to compute the new boundary so that it intersects the segments connected to the
start and finish points that you define.
The start and finish points (markers) are represented using a green and red circle marker. You can
always press world button on the Display toolbar which will place text labels next to the start and fin-
ish points.
- 329 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Once a solution has been found you can always preview it by pressing the Map View button.
- 330 -
Main Menu
As mentioned above, FieldGenius will compute the new boundary so that it intersects the
boundary lines connected to the start and finish points that were defined.
In the example below, the original left side of the lot now has two segments that define it. In this
example, the solution would have to intersect the boundary segments from (108 - 9001) and from (46 -
62). If we use the same predetermine area parameters as above, FieldGenius will not be able to com-
pute a solution because the solution does not intersect the two segments.
- 331 -
Stonex FieldGenius
However if the direction for the boundary is changed to 130°, and the area amount changed to 7000, a
solution can be computed because the solution intersects the two segments connected to the start
and finish points.
If you did want to keep the same area amount and direction, all you would need to do is change the
starting point.
- 332 -
Main Menu
Storing a Solution
When you have a solution that you want to store simply press the Save Point button or buttons
depending on the solution method you used. If you used the parallel method you will have two solu-
tions to choose from. You can switch to the Map view and turn the World button off if you want to see
some temporary text labels next to the computed solution points.
Triangle Calculator
Main Menu | Calculations | Triangle Calculator
The triangle calculator can be used to solve unknown sides or angle of a triangle given three know
components.
- 333 -
Stonex FieldGenius
You first need to select a Method for the triangle calculation. There are 5 methods available to choose
from and you can decide what method to use based on your known triangle components.
l Side-Side-Side: Use this when you know the length of the three sides of a triangle.
l Angle-Side-Angle: Use this when you know two angles and the distance between them.
l Side-Angle-Angle: Use this when you know two angles and one side. The know side must
not lie in between the two known angles.
l Side-Angle-Side: Use this when two sides and the angle between them are known.
l Side-Side-Angle: Use this when two sides and one angle that is not between the known
sides are known. This method will produce two solutions.
After you choose the solution method and enter the known components of the triangle, press the
View Results button to complete the calculation.
- 334 -
Main Menu
Coordinate Calculator
Main Menu | Calculations | Coordinate Calculator
The coordinate calculator is used to convert Geodetic coordinates to Cartesian coordinates and vice
versa. You can also use it to convert ellipsoid heights to orthometric heights if you have defined a
geoid.
Define Coordinate Systems
Press the Select Coordinate Systems button to select the coordinate system and geoid you want to
use.
In the following example the user chose to convert between UTM NAD83 Zone 11 to Lat and Long
WGS 84. Also at the same time the elevation is being converted from an ellipsoid height to an ortho-
metric height using the Canadian HT2.0 geoid.
- 335 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Convert Coordinate
Once you've defined the coordinate systems you want to convert between you can then enter some
numbers.
Press the Convert button to make the computation.
- 336 -
Main Menu
Information
Press the information button to see details about the coordinate system such as grid scale, and con-
vergence angle.
Scientific Calculator
Main Menu | Calculations | Scientific Calculator
FieldGenius includes an RPN (Reverse Polish Notation) Calculator. RPN Calculators (such as the
HP48) are stack based, where values are popped from a stack, and the results of the calculation are
pushed back onto the stack. This type of calculator may seem foreign at first, so several examples of
its use are included below.
The calculator can be launched several ways:
1. By tapping inside certain numeric entry fields to directly open the Calculator. This will copy
whatever value is currently in that entry field into the calculator's command line, and the cal-
culated value can then be automatically copied back into the field which the calculator was
launched from.
2. By tapping inside most text and numeric entry fields to open the keypad, and then tapping the
"Calculator" button on the keypad. This will copy whatever value was currently in that entry
field first into the keypad and then into the calculator's command line. The calculated value
can then be automatically copied back into the keypad and then to the field which the cal-
culator was launched from.
3. It can be launched from the map screen using its Keyboard Shortcut (default is the F key).
4. Or it can be launched through the menu system.
- 337 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The Stack
The stack is a series of memory storage locations for numeric data. Each location in the stack is
called a Level. There are a maximum of 20 Levels available in the Stack.
As you push new values on the stack, the stack grows to accommodate them: the new data moves
into level 1, and older data is pushed to a higher level. Data in level 1 will move to level 2, data in level
2 to level 3, and so on. Any data in level 20 will be bumped off the stack if new data is added, and is
unrecoverable. As you pop data off of the stack, the number of levels decrease as data is auto-
matically bumped down to lower levels.
The stack display always shows levels 1 to 5, and you can use the scroll bar to view the other levels
up to level 20.
The Command Line
The command line is where you enter or edit data. You can enter up to 20 characters in the command
line.
The command line is closely tied to the stack. You use it to enter or edit data and then process it, and
the results are pushed onto level 1 of the stack.
Function
Numeric Entry
You can enter values using the keys provided on the calculator or use the numeric keys on your key-
board.
[ 0 ] - [ 9 ] - Types numeric data into the command line
- 338 -
Main Menu
[ ← ] - Types a backspace into the command line. You can also use the Backspace key on your key-
board.
Stack Operations
Functions are available to help you manipulate data that is currently stored in the stack.
[ EDIT ] - Pops data from level 1 of the stack into the command line, bumping all other data down one
level.
[ SWAP ] - Switches positions of the data in levels 1 and 2 of the stack. Or you can highlight a level
on the stack and pressing the Swap button will move the value to level 1.
[ CLEAR ] - Deletes all data from the stack.
[ DROP ] - Deletes the data in level 1 of the stack, bumping all other data down one level.
[ ENTER ] - Pushes data from the command line into level 1 of the stack, bumping all other data up
one level. You can also use your keyboard's Enter key.
The Shift Button
[ SHIFT ] - This is used to show the reverse functions of each operation.
When the shift key highlighted in grey, it indicates that the shift key is currently depressed, press it
again to un-shift
- 339 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Note:
All data will remain on the Stack, and will be available the next time the calculator is
re-started. On Exiting from FieldGenius, all data on the stack is written out to a file
called CalcStack.bin and will be automatically re-loaded when FieldGenius is re-star-
ted.
Converting Units
[ METER ] , [ FEET ] , [ FTUS ]
Assigns a linear unit to the data in the Command Line, and places it on the Stack. If the Command
Line is empty, then the unit is applied to the data currently in Level 1 of the Stack.
[ DEG ] , [ RAD ] , [ GRAD ]
Assigns an angular unit to the data in the Command Line, and places it on the Stack. If the Command
Line is empty, then the unit is applied to the data currently in Level 1 of the Stack.
Note:
- 340 -
Main Menu
You do not need to press enter before pressing a unit button, it will automatically
move whatever data is in the Command Line into Level 1 of the Stack.
Example: determine the metric equivalent of 15 feet:
[1][5] [FEET] [METER]
1: 4.572_m
Example: determine the gradient equivalent of 45 degrees:
[4][5] [DEG] [GRAD]
1: 50_grad
Note:
You do not need to press [ENTER] before pressing a math button, it will automatically
move whatever data is in the Command Line into Level 1 of the Stack.
Example: determine the sum of 2 + 3
[2] [ENTER] [3] [+]
1: 5
[ P>R ] , [ R>P ]
Convert data between Polar and Rectangular notation
- 341 -
Stonex FieldGenius
[ DMS> ] , [ >DMS ]
Converts data between Degrees/Minutes/Seconds and Decimal Degrees
Example: Convert from 12° 34' 56" to decimal degrees
[1][2][.][3][4][5][6] [DMS->]
1: 12.58222222_°
Example: Convert from 12.3456° to degrees, minutes, seconds
[1][2][.][3][4][5][6] [SHIFT] [->DMS]
1: 12.204416
[ DMS+ ] , [ DMS- ]
Add or subtract DMS angles
Example: 12° 34' 56" + 1° 2' 3"
[1][2][.][3][4][5][6] [ENTER] [1][.][0][2][0][3] [DMS+]
1: 13.3659
- 342 -
Main Menu
- 343 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Instrument Selection
Main Menu | Connect
The Instrument Selection screen allows you to choose the type of equipment you will be connecting
to FieldGenius. An Instrument Profile can be created for each different instrument you will be working
with, to make changing between different hardware a breeze. Once you have setup a profile for each
different instrument you will be using, switching between them is a simple matter of selecting the
appropriate profile and pressing Connect.
Note, this screen is not available if FieldGenius is running onboard your instrument.
For all future Projects you create with FieldGenius, when you create a new or open an existing Project
you will see the Instrument Selection screen with the profiles you have already created. It will default
to the last Profile you used, so if you are using the same instrument just press Connect. If you are
using different equipment, just select the appropriate Instrument Type and Profile (or add a new profile
if one does not yet exist for it), then press Connect.
Your profiles are stored in the Settings.xml file within the ...\Stonex\FieldGenius\FG Projects\
(Windows CE/Mobile) or ...\Documents\Stonex\FieldGenius\FG Projects\ (Windows Tablet/PC)
directory so once you have configured one data collector, you can copy this file onto other data col-
lectors to make the profiles available on them. This file should also be backed up for easy recovery.
- 344 -
Main Menu
Total Station
When you select the Total Station instrument type, you will be able to Add, Delete, or Edit a profile
for your conventional and robotic total stations. See the Total Station Configuration topic for more
details about configuration for your total station.
For more information on connecting to your instrument please refer to the Conventional Total Station
and Robotic Total Station topics.
Disto/Laser
When you select the Disto/Laser instrument type, you will be able to Add, Delete, or Edit a profile for
your supported Leica Disto and supported Laser Technology Inc devices. Please review the Dis-
to/Laser Reference topic for more details.
Simulators
GNSS Rover Demo
When you select GNSS Rover Demo from the Simulators instrument type, you will be able to Edit
and Connect to a profile for a simulated GNSS Rover receiver. When you edit the RTK Demo profile,
you will see the Configure Rover screen. For more information about using FieldGenius for GNSS sur-
veying, you should review the GNSS Overview topics.
The GNSS Rover Demo will simulate connecting FieldGenius to a GNSS Rover receiver. The
coordinates in the GNSS Demo are located outside our office in Westbank, British Columbia,
Canada, so to use the GNSS Demo mode you need to set your Coordinate System Settings to UTM
Zones, NAD83, UTM83-11, Ellipsoidal.
Total Station Demo
When you select Total Station Demo from the Simulators instrument type, you will be able to Edit
and Connect to a profile for a simulated Total Station. All measurements are manually entered, but
point coordinates and the raw file are updated as if connected to an instrument.
- 345 -
Stonex FieldGenius
None
Use this option if you're not connecting anything to FieldGenius. With this mode, the instrument tool-
bar will not be displayed in the map screen.
- 346 -
Main Menu
Staking Menu
Main Menu | Staking
Instrument Toolbar | Measure Modes | Staking
This menu contains staking related functions.
Stake Points
Use this to stake points from a list or from a screen selection. Please see the Stake Points topic for
more information.
Stake Line
Use this to stake lines and arcs. Please see the Stake Line topic for more information.
Stake Elevation
Use this to stake a specific design elevation. Please see the Stake Elevation topic for more inform-
ation.
Stake Alignment
Use this to open the alignment tools screen. Please see the Stake Alignment topic for more inform-
ation.
Stake Surface
Use this to stake to a DTM (Digital Terrain Model) surface. Please see the Stake Surface topic for
more information.
- 347 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Staking List
Use this to define a staking list that can be used for staking. Please see the Staking List topic for
more information.
Point on Wall
Use this to auto-locate on the wall surface where an offset point intersects perpendicular. Please see
the Point on Wall topic for more information.
Point on Floor and Point on Ceiling
Use this to auto-locate on the floor or ceiling surface where an offset point intersects perpendicular.
Please see the Point on Floor or Ceiling topic for more information.
Pipe through Wall
Use this to auto-locate on the wall surface the intersection point of the projection of a pipe. Please
see the Pipe Through Wall topic for more information.
Stake Points
Main Menu | Staking | Stake Point
Point Toolbar | Stake
Step 1: Select Design Point
When you start the stake points command you will be able to pick a point from the map, or enter a
point id in the point id field, or use a point list by turning on the "Use List" toggle.
- 348 -
Main Menu
Point ID
This allows you to manually enter in the point you would like to stake.
Point Desc
This shows the description of the current design point.
Previous & Next
Use this to automatically advance to the next or previous point in your database. Note that you need
to have a value entered in the point number field.
If you have a staking list defined, using these buttons will advance to the next or previous point
sequence in the staking list.
Nearest Search
This will automatically select the closet point to stake.
Use List
Use this to force the staking routine to use the staking list you created. If you haven't created a stak-
ing list yet, you can press the Edit List button which will take you to the staking list editor.
Edit Staking List
Use this to open the staking list editor. Please see the Staking List topic for more information.
- 349 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 350 -
Main Menu
- 351 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Staking Toolbar
The staking toolbar is used in conjunction with the Observation Toolbar to help you navigate to your
stake point. If you're using a robotic or conventional instrument the staking process will be similar.
The staking toolbar can be accessed by pressing the Stake Point button on the Stake Points screen.
It will also be accessed from many other commands that require a point to be staked.
When you first see the staking screen you may be asked to take a measurement first so it can cal-
culate the current position of the rod. Press the measure button if you're using a conventional instru-
ment, or turn on the cursor tracking button if you're using a robot or GNSS.
You should define a map orientation in the staking settings. Setting this will twist your map view to
help you with your stakeout and change the way the "move by" distance are reported. Press the top
button "Viewing North/Instrument/Prism" to adjust your Orientation Reference setting. For best res-
ults, set the Orientation Reference to Prism for a conventional total station, Instrument for a robotic
total station, North for GPNS staking.
Grid Staking Mode is selected by default, select the Grid button on the bottom-left corner will allows
you to choose Map staking mode that relays on Observation Toolbar, or Compass staking method if
you are using a GNSS receiver or robotic total station.
Note that Compass staking mode for GNSS will require movements to determine the orientation to
the point you are trying to stake. Once you are close to the point, the screen will automatically switch
to Grid mode for precise staking. The threshold of this switch can be found inside Staking Settings
menu.
- 352 -
Main Menu
Buttons
Store Point
When this is pressed the Store / Edit Points
screen will appear so you can store the position
of the rod. The default is to store a point in the
project database as well as write raw records to
the raw file. You might not want to store a point
for the staked position but want to have a record
of it in the raw file. This can be done by turning
off "Store Staked Point" in Stake Settings. (This
button not available for GNSS staking, use the
Measure button to record the point.)
Select Viewing Direction
This opens up Viewing Direction dialogue where
you can select options depending on the current
instrument
Current options include: Viewing North/In-
strument/Prism/User Point.
Select Staking Method
Depending on the instrument selected, this but-
ton allows you to choose from Map, Grid, Com-
pass staking modes.
Staking Information
This displays information about the point you
are staking. It will list the coordinates of the
point plus other information that will help you dur-
ing your stakeout.
Toggle Observation View
This button allows you to see or hide the Obser-
vation Toolbar.
Select Next Point
This button opens up options to select next
point to Stake
- 353 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Zoom
Map View only - This will automatically zoom to
the extents of your current target position and
the point you're staking.
Settings
This will open the Staking Settings screen
which allows you to setup parameters that will
be used during the stakeout such as your Tol-
erance, Orientation Reference, and more.
Close
This will close the Staking Toolbar, and return
you to the previous screen.
- 354 -
Main Menu
To help with navigating, set your map orientation to Prism in the staking settings screen. This will
force the map to orientate itself so the prism is at the top and the instrument is at the bottom.
You can use the Turn An Angle method to quickly get online with your point, then switch to the Dir-
ectional method to navigate accurately to the point.
Robotic Total Station Tips
If you're using a robotic instrument you need to turn on the cursor tracking button on the instrument
toolbar before the navigate distances are displayed. Note that with a robotic instrument, there is no
need to press the measure button as the cursor tracking provides real-time positions to the Obser-
vation Toolbar.
To help with navigating, set your map orientation to Instrument in the Settings screen. This will force
the map to orientate itself so the instrument is at the top and the prism is at the bottom.
You can set the EDM mode on the instrument toolbar to use a fine measurement setting that can be
used to record the position of the point. When cursor tracking is on it uses a coarse mode which might
not be suitable for the storing the point, but suitable enough to for navigation. For precise stakeout you
can use the following procedure:
- 355 -
Stonex FieldGenius
GNSS Tips
To help with navigating, set your map orientation to North in the settings screen. This will force the
map to orient itself so that North remains up on the screen.
Use cursor tracking to navigate to your point (this provides real-time positions to the Observation Tool-
bar) then when you attain the final position to be staked press the Measure button. The usual GNSS
Measurement procedure will apply, and your current tolerance mode and masks will be in effect for
the measurement.
Raw File
When you store your point several records are written to the raw file. Following is an example of a
point that was staked out:
SP,PN1400,N 715346.319,E 2381454.812,EL1.009,--
CF,EL1.0087,GD1.0000
DE,PN342,N 715346.319,E 2381454.770,EL1.000,--
SD,ND-0.000,ED-0.042,LD-0.009
- 356 -
Main Menu
Stake Line/Arc
Main Menu | Staking | Stake Line
Line Toolbar | Stake
Stake Line
When you start the command from the Staking Menu you will see the Select Line Toolbar that will
allow you to select the object you want to stake.
- 357 -
Stonex FieldGenius
If you want to stake the line, just press the Line Staking button which will take you to the Map View
screen and wait for an observation to be taken.
If you want to stake a specific point along the line, select the Point On Line Staking button and spe-
cify the station/offset distances then press the Stake Point button which will display the stake point
toolbar for the specified design point.
When the stake line toolbar opens you have to take a shot before any information will appear on the
toolbar.
- 358 -
Main Menu
Staking Methods
For each of the following methods, if you are within the Tolerance setting defined in the Staking Set-
tings, then the direction/distance text will be green; if you are outside the tolerance then the text will
be red. You can also switch pages within the Observation Toolbar at any time to see other meas-
urement information, for example if you want to see the rod elevation instead of a Cut/Fill.
Directional
This method will display the current Station (perpendicular from the rod, as marked by a blue circle on
the line), the In/Out, Left/Right, or N/S/E/W distance to the line (from the rod to the red x on the line,
keeping the same horizontal angle), and the Cut/Fill distance (from the rod to the interpolated elev-
ation of the station point marked by the blue circle, where a cut represents that the rod is higher than
the interpolated station elevation, and a fill represent that the rod is lower than the interpolated station
elevation) in the Observation Toolbar near the top of the screen.
When using this method, be sure to set the "Orientation Reference" option to Prism for a conventional
total station, Instrument for a robotic total station, North for GNSS staking, or use one of the other ref-
erence options if preferred.
You can force FieldGenius to display either In/Out or Left/Right distances by changing the Line Mode
option in the Staking Settings.
- 359 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Stationing - Absolute
This method will display the current Station, Offset, and Cut/Fill distances relative to the line in the
Observation Toolbar near the top of the screen. The station point is marked by a blue circle on the
line, the Offset is the Left/Right distance from the blue station point to the current rod position, and the
Cut/Fill is the elevation difference from the current rod position to the interpolated elevation of the sta-
tion point where a cut represents that the rod is higher than the interpolated station elevation, and a fill
represent that the rod is lower than the interpolated station elevation.
Stationing - Relative
This method will display the current Station, Offset, and Cut/Fill distances relative to the line in the
Observation Toolbar near the top of the screen. The station point is marked by a blue circle on the
line, the Offset is the Left/Right distance from the blue station point to the current rod position, and the
Cut/Fill is the elevation difference from the current rod position to the interpolated elevation of the sta-
tion point where a cut represents that the rod is higher than the interpolated station elevation, and a fill
represent that the rod is lower than the interpolated station elevation.
Note:
Please refer to the Point Staking Toolbar topic for additional information and tips.
Stake Arc
The process is identical whether staking a line or an arc - the only difference is you begin by selecting
or defining an arc instead of a line.
- 360 -
Main Menu
Just like staking to a line, Staking to an Arc gives the user the option to either stake anywhere along
the selected arc by selecting the "Line Staking" button. Or the user can also indicate a desired point
along the line by selecting the "Point On Line Staking" button and enter in a station and offset.
Stake Alignment
Main Menu | Staking | Stake Alignment
- 361 -
Stonex FieldGenius
When this is selected, the Alignment Staking screen will be displayed. Note you first need to define
an alignment in the Road Manager screen. Use this to quickly continue staking your alignment.
Please see the Road Reference section for more detailed information about creating and defining
alignments.
Stake Surface
Main Menu | Staking | Stake Surface
The Stake Surface command allows you to take a shot anywhere on a surface and a cut or fill value
will be computed. The current northing and easting position of the rod is based on the measurement,
but the Z value is computed by intersecting the surface at the rod location.
You will first be prompted to select a surface to stake. If you have already imported and turned on the
TIN or Contours for any surfaces, they will be displayed in the list for you to choose from. If the list is
empty, you need to use the Surface Manager to import or enable one. Please refer to the Surface Man-
ager topic for more information on how to load a surface.
When you first see the staking toolbar you may see the words "Waiting for data" in the Observation
Toolbar which means you need to take a measurement first so it can calculate the current position of
the rod. Press the measure button if you're using a conventional instrument, or turn on the cursor
tracking button if you're using a robot or GPS.
- 362 -
Main Menu
Once you take a shot you will see the following information in the Observation Toolbar near the top of
the screen: the Design elevation based on the surface model's elevation at your rod's horizontal pos-
ition, the actual Height or elevation of the rod, and the Cut or Fill between the two. To help you visu-
alize where your shot is in relation to the surface you can always use our 3D view capabilities.
Staking Method
Unlike Point or Line/Arc staking, there is only one available staking method: Height.
Store Point
When this is pressed the Store / Edit Points screen will appear so you can store the position that was
staked. Also a raw record will be written to the raw file.
Information
This isn't applicable when staking to a surface and will be grayed out.
Zoom
This isn't applicable when staking to a surface and will be grayed out.
Settings
This will open the Staking Settings screen which allows you to setup parameters that will be used dur-
ing the staking process.
Note:
Please refer to the Point Staking Toolbar topic for additional information and tips.
- 363 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Stake Elevation
Main Menu | Staking | Stake Elevation
This routine allows you to stake to a specific elevation (called the Design elevation). The routine will
report the cut and fill values from the selected (Design) elevation to your current rod elevation. The
horizontal position is not the focus of this routine.
Why would I want to use this? Maybe you may want to use this function if you have to stake a build-
ing pad before concrete is poured and you know what the height of the pad should be. You enter this
value in the Elevation field and walk around your pad. This routine will inform you of how far your rod
is above or below the design elevation.
The first step is to define your constant elevation. You can either type in a design elevation manually
into the Elevation field, or you can use the Get elevation from point... button to select a point from
your points database, and use its elevation.
Continue
Press this button to continue to the Map view. You will now see the map screen displaying the Stak-
ing toolbar. The Display toolbar displays the design elevation (the intended or desired elevation), the
actual measured elevation (displayed in the Elev field), and the cut/fill amount required to get to the
design elevation from the measured elevation.
Design = Elev+ Fill amount or
Design = Elev - Cut amount
- 364 -
Main Menu
Staking List
Main Menu | Staking | Staking List
Use a staking list to stake points from a predetermined list of points.
Why Use a Staking List?
The staking list is separate from the Points database. We have added intelligence to the staking list
specifically for staking out. After importing points and assigning the "To Stake Out" survey role to
them, you will never have a measured point appear as a point to be staked out. Moreover, the staking
list will always search for and present the next nearest point (shortest path) from the current position
as the next point to stake out. This functionality was added to help you stake out more points in a day.
When you start the staking list command you will see the staking list screen and it will be empty, if
you haven't previously added any points to it. The image below is of a staking list that contains
points.
- 365 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Sort By Point ID
Use this to sort the staking list by Point ID.
Sort By Shortest Path
Select the first point you want to stake, then use this to sort the staking list by shortest path distance
from the selected point.
Find Points
Use this to find points that will be added to the list. You can find points based on the Point ID (which
includes the ability to select points based on a window crossing in the mapview screen, by point ID
range or by a single point and radius) Coordinate, or Description. The system will look in the Points
database for points to add to the staking list.
- 366 -
Main Menu
- 367 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Select Point
Use this to pick a point from the map. Points will be added to the list in the order they're selected.
Remove Points
Use this to delete a single row or multiple rows. This will only remove the points from the list and will
not delete any points from the Points database.
Remove All Points
Use this to clear the current list. This will only remove the points from the list and will not delete any
points from the Points database.
Move Up
This will move the currently highlighted point up one row.
Move Down button:
This will move the currently highlighted point down one row.
Stake Pnt
This will take you to the staking toolbar to stake out the point that is currently highlighted in the list.
Staking Status
If a point in your staking list has not been staked yet, it will have a stake icon displayed in the Staked
Status column. You will see a green checkmark icon if the point has already been staked.
- 368 -
Main Menu
As you can see in the image above, point 1 has been staked, and point 2 has not.
Adding Points to the Staking List
There are two ways to add points to a staking list. You can add points that already exist in the Points
database via the staking list screen by pressing the Find Points button. The alternative (and possibly
the easiest) way is to assign the survey role of To Stake Out to points being imported via the ASCII
Coordinate File Import button in the Import/Export Menu. When points are imported using the
ASCII Coordinate File Import button and are assigned the survey role of To Stake Out, these
points will automatically be added to the staking list.
Working From the List
To work from the list simply highlight the point you wish to stake and press the Stake Pnt button
which will begin the process. Please see the Point Staking Toolbar topic for more information. Since
you started from the staking list, it will automatically turn on the "Use Staking List" checkbox in the
Stake Points screen.
When you store your stake point, the stake point command will automatically go to the next point in
the list.
Survey Role Setting
The status of a point is controlled by the Survey Role type in the project database. You can view the
role by using the Coordinate Database viewer. If the point is pending, it will have a survey role type of
"to stake out" (point 2 in the image below). If it has been staked, it will have a survey role of staked
out (point 1 in the image below).
- 369 -
Stonex FieldGenius
l Leica 3D Disto
l Robotic Total Station such as Leica TS, MS and iCON products
This advanced layout mode allows you to compute the position of a point on a wall using only the non
prism EDM mode. The routine will interpolate and determine the location of the wall and will compute
the theoretical perpendicular offset from the design point to the plane defining the wall. The laser
pointer on your instrument will point to the location that you should mark.
MEP Module
This advanced feature is available when the MEP module is enabled.
Procedure
Define Wall
When you start the routine you will see the Auto-Locate Point on Wall dialog.
On this dialog you can specify the point you want to locate on the wall, plus define the plane that
defines the wall.
The first option allows you to point your instrument at the existing wall and lets the software determ-
ine the existing location of the wall by taking some shots automatically to determine the plane.
The second option lets you define the wall by using an existing line in your project or by defining the
wall by two points.
- 370 -
Main Menu
Target Heights
When using the auto-locate routines you will not need to use a vertical offset. The routine will always
default the vertical offset to "No Vertical Offset" and enable "Use Auto-Location".
Important Notes
It's important to understand the importance of finding the plane that defines the wall. In the following
image you will see that a design point is to be located and marked on the wall. During construction,
walls are never perfect and will differ from the design location. Since the laser pointer is being used to
locate this point, if all the instrument did was turn to and point at the theoretical position you will see
that it would mark a spot clearly in the wrong location.
Layout will prevent this from happening by determining where the wall is by taking several shots to
derive a plane. The point is then intersected with this plane and the instrument will then turn to and
point directly at the intersection point.
- 371 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Once the location is marked you can then store it and locate your next point.
l Leica 3D Disto
l Robotic Total Station with reflectorless capabilities such as Leica TS, MS and iCON products
These advanced layout modes allow you to compute the position of a point on a floor or ceiling using
only the non prism EDM mode. The routine will interpolate and determine the location of the floor or
ceiling and will compute the theoretical intersection using the x,y location of the point. The laser
pointer on your instrument will point to the location of the layout point. Your layout points don't need to
have elevations, and only require x,y coordinates.
MEP Module
This advanced feature is only available when the MEP module is enabled on your license.
Procedure
Enable Auto-Location
The user must first enable the Auto-Locate feature to access the MEP functions. To do this go into
the Instrument Settings and click on the "Enable Auto-Location" button. This feature will only be avail-
able if the license has the MEP module added.
- 372 -
Main Menu
l Note turning the Auto-Location will automatically turn on the instruments reflectorless laser.
Ensure the instrument is not pointing in the direction of you or anyone else.
After the user has selected to stake to either the Point on Ceiling or Point on Floor the screen below
will now be displayed.
- 373 -
Stonex FieldGenius
This Auto-Locate options screen allows the user to select how the instrument searches for the point
on the plane. It also allows the user to switch the point that needs to be staked.
l Aim Laser - This option will require the user to point the instrument at the desired surface to
stake the point to.
l Use Search Algorithm - This option will automatically take as many observations as need to
define the surface to stake the point to.
- 374 -
Main Menu
After the routine has located the point on the surface the staking results screen will pop up and will dis-
play the point details and also prompt the user to either Store the Point and Continue or Continue
without storing. After this has been selected it will take you back to the Stake Point screen for the
next point to be laid out.
Target Heights
When using the auto-locate routines you will not need to use a vertical offset. The routine will always
default the vertical offset to "No Vertical Offset" and enable "Use Auto-Location".
When you start the routine it will automatically start taking measurements on the floor or ceiling
depending on the layout mode selected. The measurements will determine a plane that the design
point will be projected onto for layout.
Important Notes
It's important to understand the importance of finding the plane that defines the floor or ceiling. In the
following image you will see that a point with coordinates (1,1,0) is being located on the floor and ceil-
ing. Since the laser pointer is being used to locate this point, if all the instrument did was turn to and
point at the theoretical position you will see that it would mark a spot clearly in the wrong location.
Layout will determine where the floor or ceiling is by taking several shots to derive a plane. The point
is then intersected with this plane and the instrument will then turn to and point directly at the inter-
section point.
- 375 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Once the location is marked you can then store it and locate your next point.
- 376 -
Main Menu
l Leica 3D Disto
l Robotic Total Station such as Leica TS, MS and iCON products
This advanced layout mode allows you to compute the penetration location of a pipe through a wall
using only the non prism EDM mode. The routine will interpolate and determine the location of the wall
and will compute the theoretical penetration point and the laser pointer on your instrument will point to
the location that you should mark.
MEP Module
This advanced feature is available when the MEP module is enabled.
Procedure
Define Pipe and Wall
When you start the routine you will see the Auto-Locate Point on Wall dialog. On this dialog you can
specify the pipe centerline by selecting two points or an existing line in your project.
The second option lets you define the wall by pointing at it with your instrument, or by letting the soft-
ware find the wall automatically.
Target Heights
When using the auto-locate routines you will not need to use a vertical offset. The routine will always
default the vertical offset to "No Vertical Offset" and enable "Use Auto-Location".
- 377 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Important Notes
It's important to understand the importance of finding the plane that defines the wall. During con-
struction, walls are never perfect and will differ from the design location. Since the laser pointer is
being used to locate the penetration point, the software must determine the current location of the
wall.
Layout will determine where the wall is by taking several shots to derive a plane. The pipe line is then
intersected with this plane and the instrument will then turn to and point directly at the penetration
point.
- 378 -
Main Menu
Import / Export
Main Menu | Import / Export
Use this menu to display different options for importing data into or exporting data out of your Project.
Points / Observations
ASCII Coordinates
You can import and export ASCII coordinates to/from your current Project. Please see the Import
ASCII Coordinates and Export ASCII Coordinates topics for more information.
SIMA
FieldGenius now supports the importing and exporting the SIMA format. Please see the SIMA Import
and SIMA Export ASCII topics for more information.
SDR Export
The SDR Export in FieldGenius will convert the existing raw file into a SDR 33 compatible format.
Please see the SDR File Export topic for more information.
Fieldbook File Export
Use this to export a Softdesk FBK file that will contain your coordinates, raw observations and figure
information. Please see the Fieldbook File Export topic for more information.
- 379 -
Stonex FieldGenius
CR5 Coordinates
FieldGenius now supports the exporting of the CR5 format in both sequential and non-sequential
formats. Please see the CR5 Export topic for more information.
GNSS Survey Report
You can export out a report with important GNSS information relating to the horizontal and vertical
system used, individual stored point statistics including satellites used, accuracy and solution type
as well as other information relating to the point location. The report will be in PDF or HTML format,
depending on your device. Please see the Survey Report topic for more information.
CAD / LandXML / Templates
DXF/DWG/DGN
Import DXF/DWG/DGN files into your current Project. Please see the Import DXF/DWG/DGN File
and Map Data Layers topics for more information. When importing in a DWG or DGN files there are
some limitations with regards to the file size being imported and the data collector being used. Should
you experience any graphical display issues, try importing in a smaller file or unloading the file entirely
to clear it up.
Export DXF/DWG files of your current Project. The file will contain drawing entities of your points and
lines. Please see the Export DXF/DWG File topic for more information.
LandXML
Import and export LandXML files. Exported files can contain CgPoints and Chains. The file will be
saved in your current Project directory. Please see the LandXML Import and LandXML Export topics
for more information.
Templates
Import and export templates of figures and points to/from your current Project. Please see the Import
Template and Export Template topics for more information.
Cut Sheet Reports
FieldGenius can create various cutsheet reports. Please see the Cutsheet Reports topic for more
information.
GIS Files
Shapefiles
FieldGenius now supports the importing and exporting of ESRI shapefiles. Please see the Shapefile
Export topic for more information.
- 380 -
Main Menu
KML Export
FieldGenius now supports the ability to export out a KML file format. Please see the KML Export topic
for more information.
Coordinate Systems
You can import and export user-defined coordinate systems. Please see the Coordinate Systems
topic for more information.
Notes:
- For importing DXF/DWG/DGN, LandXML, and raster image files, please see the
Map Data Layers topic in the Data Manager menu.
- For importing DTM surface files, please see the Surfaces topic in the Data Manager
menu.
Points / Observations
ASCII Coordinate Import
Main Menu | Import / Export | Points / Observations | ASCII Coordinate Import
Use this option to import a list of coordinates to the current Project.
- 381 -
Stonex FieldGenius
This may be required if a separate coordinate file is uploaded to the device by itself (not as part of a
Project with linework). This is also useful for transfer of points from one file to another.
Function
1. Click on the "Browse for File..." button to navigate to and select your file.
2. Choose the field delimiter, either Comma or Space.
3. Choose the file format. See below for more information regarding file format. If you are uncer-
tain, use the Standard format.
4. Use the assigned role field to select the survey role of the points being imported. If these
points are to go into the staking list, then select To Stake Out as the survey role.
5. Write SP (Store Point) record to raw file will store the imported coordinates to the raw file.
This is very useful if you wish to reprocess coordinates later, so we recommend that you
select this when importing points.
6. Overwrite Existing Coordinates - allows you to control whether points will be overwritten dur-
ing the import.
7. Set as Control Points – will set a flag in the database that will prevent these points from
being edited or changed in FieldGenius (under any circumstances!)
8. Choose OK to import the coordinates, Cancel to abort the import.
9. You will be shown a confirmation of how many points were imported to the current Project.
File Formats
Both space and comma delimited files are supported.
For all formats, the order of the Northing and Easting fields are determined by setting the Coordinate
Order in the Options screen.
Standard
ID, Northing/Y or Easting/X, Easting/X or Northing/Y, Elevation, Descrip-
tion:Note
This format expects the file to be in a standard ASCII format. If your descriptions have a colon in
them, then FieldGenius will store everything before the colon as a description, and everything after
the colon will be considered to be a note.
Standard with Header
Same as the Standard format, but the first row in the file is ignored.
- 382 -
Main Menu
Extended
ID, Northing/Y or Easting/X, Easting/X or Northing/Y, Elevation, Descrip-
tion, Note, Latitude, Longitude, Ellipsoidal Height, Latitude StdDev, Lon-
gitude StdDev, Height StdDev
This format is different than the standard such that notes are separate from descriptions. Also if you
collected GNSS data, the WGS 84 information can also be included and imported along with other
information related to the GNSS point.
Extended with Header
Same as the Extended format, but the first row in the file is ignored.
More about the Extended Format
If you import a FieldGenius extended file format ASCII file, FieldGenius will create EP and GS
records in the raw file. Also, the coordinates will be imported and stored in the database. Importing
this type of file is useful for seeding points when using the OmniStar GNSS system or to create a list
of geodetic and cartesian points that you can select while programming a GNSS base receiver.
- 383 -
Stonex FieldGenius
l Using the horizontal and Vertical datum settings you've defined in your coordinate system set-
tings, FieldGenius will compute a Cartesian coordinate for each point using the Geodetic val-
ues imported from the ASCII file.
l A point is stored in the Project database using the Cartesian Coordinates that was computed.
The point will be assigned the point number that was imported from the ASCII file.
l A GS record is written in the raw file using the Cartesian Coordinates as a reference.
l An EP record is written to the raw file using the Geodetic Coordinates as a reference.
- 384 -
Main Menu
Function
1. Specify a range of point to export in the form #..#. Accept default of All if desired.
2. Specify the number of decimal places to carry on the export. (maximum=6)
3. Specify if you want to export them with either a space or comma delimiter.
4. Specify the Angular format.
5. Specify the Encoding format.
l ANSI - This is the default format for ASCII, which is compatible with majority of the
CAD programs such as Autodesk products.
l UNICODE - This is for use with non-English characters in the Description or Note
fields.
6. Include Header will add a header row to the exported file.
7. Include Averaging Measurements - This will include all the temporary observations of all the
averaged points into the exported file
8. Choose the file format type that you want to use. See below for more details about the different
file formats. If you are uncertain, use the Standard format.
9. Choose Export to export the coordinates, or Cancel to abort the export.
10. Browse to the folder where you want to save the file, enter a filename including an extension,
then press Save File. FieldGenius will not add any extension to the filename you enter.
11. You will be shown a confirmation of how many points were exported.
- 385 -
Stonex FieldGenius
File Formats
Both space and comma delimited files are supported.
For all formats, the order of the Northing and Easting fields are determined by setting the Coordinate
Order in the Options screen.
Standard
ID, Northing/Y or Easting/X, Easting/X or Northing/Y, Elevation, Descrip-
tion:Note
This format will append any notes you have to your description, separated by a colon.
FieldGenius has recently added two check boxes to include the Header and the Averaging Meas-
urements to the ASCII file when exporting.
Extended
ID, Northing/Y or Easting/X, Easting/X or Northing/Y, Elevation, Descrip-
tion, Note, Latitude, Longitude, EllipsoidalHeight, LatitudeStdDev, Lon-
gitudeStdDev, HeightStdDev
This format is different than the Standard such that notes are separated from descriptions.
If you collected GNSS data, the WGS 84 information will also be exported along with other inform-
ation related to the GNSS point. The WGS 84 information will be extracted from your GS records in
the raw file.
Extended with Header
Same as the Extended format, but with Header data in the first row.
CST
This is a predefined format intended for Leica ELLIPSE Neo software
- 386 -
Main Menu
Custom Formats
FieldGenius has the option to create a customized ASCII file for exporting. This option allows the
user to add additional information to the standard ASCII file format. Simply click in the grey area to
add in an extra info line and select what you wish to add in from the pull down menu.
There is also an "Options" button in the upper right corner where you can specifically request the
ASCII file to either sort by Point ID or Measurement type as select what GNSS time format.
- 387 -
Stonex FieldGenius
SIMA Import
Main Menu | Import / Export | Points / Observations | SIMA Import
FieldGenius supports importing coordinates stored in SIMA format. SIMA is a Japanese domestic
standard.
SIMA Export
Main Menu | Import / Export | Points / Observations | SIMA Export
FieldGenius supports exporting coordinates in SIMA format. SIMA is a Japanese domestic standard.
SDR Export
Main Menu | Import / Export | Points / Observations | SDR Export
The SDR Export in FieldGenius will convert the existing raw file into a SDR 33 compatible format. It
is important to note that currently not all existing raw record types are exported through the SDR
export.
Currently the following types are exported:
- 388 -
Main Menu
l Store Points
l Job Info
l Units
l Notes / Comments
l Occupy Setups
l Sideshots
l Stakeout shots
l Target Heights
l Resection measurements are not exported, but computed resection point exported as Store
Point.
l The resulting SS or TR shot for multisets will be exported as a sideshot.
l The resulting SS or TR shot for angle or distance offsets will be exported as a sideshot.
l Calculated points will be stored as a Store Point
l Adjusted Points are exported as Store Points
Fieldbook Export
Main Menu | Import / Export | Points / Observations | Fieldbook Export
Use this option to export FieldGenius database points and figure information from the current project
in a Fieldbook (.FBK) format for import into non-Stonex desktop software such as AutoCAD's Land
Development Desktop.
FieldGenius users who have Stonex Geomatics CAD Desktop software will not need to use this func-
tion as our products import standard FieldGenius raw data.
This function is designed for post processing so is best used after all fieldwork is complete. The raw
file observations are not included in the FBK file, you can read the FieldGenius raw file into Survey
Link included with LDD. You can then make your edits to the raw file and import it to LDD.
- 389 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 390 -
Main Menu
- 391 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Importing Steps
1. From the main menu, press the Data Manager button then the Map Data Layers button.
2. Press the Add File button on the Layer Manager.
3. Using the browse window, find the DXF file you would like to import and press the Open File
button.
4. Use the Layer Manager to turn on or off any layers you don't want to view.
5. Press Close and return to the map view.
6. Press the zoom extents button to see your entire DXF file.
For more information on the layer manager please visit the Layer Manager topic.
Important Notes:
- Your CAD desktop system likely has a super fast processor and 1GB or more of
RAM but most current Windows CE devices run at 206Mhz and have 32 or maybe
64MB of RAM. For this reason, you will not be able to manipulate a 5MB DXF file with
the same speed as your desktop system so minimize the size of the DXF files for
most efficient operation.
- TEXT is the biggest performance reducer in your DXF files. For best performance,
minimize the amount of text in the DXF files or turn off layers containing text when not
needed.
DXF/DWG Export
Main Menu | Import / Export | CAD / LandXML / Templates | DXF/DWG Export
Use this to export your current FieldGenius drawing as a DXF or DWG file. This allows for easy
import of linework and nodes into most cad or graphic systems
- 392 -
Main Menu
Function
- 393 -
Stonex FieldGenius
l Upon export, FieldGenius will compare the figure name to see if it has a match in the AutoMap
file. If it does, FieldGenius will draw the points along the figure, as well as draw the figure on
the layer specified in the AutoMap library.
l Points that are exported will match the point color settings set in the AutoMap library.
l Figures that don't have a match in the AutoMap library will be drawn on a layer named
"Default". Color setting will be set to 256.
l Points or nodes will be 2D or 3D depending on the Z value.
l Lines will be 2D or 3D depending on the Z values of the end points.
l Figures will be drawn as polylines.
l Curvy lines or arcs will be drawn as segmented polylines. FieldGenius will automatically inter-
polate an elevation along the arc or curved section of the figure at 1° intervals.
l Contours will be drawn as polylines and will be 3D based on the contour elevation.
l Points or nodes will appear as an "X" marker in the DXF file because the PDMODE variable is
being set to 3 in the DXF file. In most desktop CAD programs you can change this marker type
by typing PDMODE.
LandXML Import
Main Menu | Import / Export | CAD / LandXML / Templates | LandXML Import
FieldGenius can import LandXML files. Rather than convert these files into some different format, you
can read these files directly into FieldGenius.
Importing a LandXML File
There are several different methods of importing a LandXML file:
- 394 -
Main Menu
When a LandXML file is read, it is scanned to make a list of the objects that it contains. Loading the
entire file into the FieldGenius Project could use many megabytes of valuable memory. Therefore,
when you wish to use data from a LandXML file, you need to load it as needed. Sample LandXML files
are available at the LandXML web site: www.landxml.org
One of the example files posted is subdivision-xsec.xml. We have downloaded and are now going to
show the results of reading it into FieldGenius:
- 395 -
Stonex FieldGenius
l Fast: We can use the points that define the surface and let FieldGenius re-calculate the TIN
model. This might be acceptable for an area where no attempt was made to edit the triangles
or add break lines. FieldGenius can compute a surface in seconds from large numbers of
points.
l Maintain Triangulation: we can force FieldGenius to read the TIN exactly as computed by the
desktop software. This requires much more computing by the import program, but it will
exactly maintain the triangulation in the original surface. For example, if the LandXML surface
was created by using breaklines and hand editing, you will want to maintain the exact triangles
for staking and viewing the surface.
You can set the import method by going to the Main Menu | Data Manager | Surfaces | Surface
Options.
From the Surface Manager you can see a list of the surfaces in the XML file. Select the one you want
to load.
Alignments, Profiles, and Cross Sections
Alignments, cross sections, and staking of these items are some of the powerful features in
FieldGenius. Almost all modern road design software will export alignments in LandXML format. We
read the horizontal alignment (which is normally at elevation zero), the vertical profile, and the cross
sections from LandXML files. Individual components can be selected for staking or viewing inform-
ation. The Project Manager is used for visibility of these items, and you can drill down into the com-
ponents right to the coordinate level.
Reading the basic alignment information is done when you import the LandXML file. Alignments gen-
erally are not too large, so we read the alignment, profile and cross sections into memory for later use.
There may be several surfaces in an alignment, so you can view each cross section surface sep-
arately. Each may be staked. In this sample file, there are several alignments. Each alignment can be
turned on or off, or just the cross sections for an alignment can be turned off.
Following is a tiny excerpt from the first few lines of this LandXML file. Fortunately, it is rarely neces-
sary to open a file; however, if you open one in Internet Explorer, you will see the format. They are eas-
ily explored, because you can "collapse" sections of the file by picking on the negative signs at the
beginning of the lines in Internet Explorer. In this picture, all of the file has been collapsed except for
the header. It is easy to see that the file was created by Autodesk Land Desktop version 3 with Ser-
vice Pack 1 installed.
- 396 -
Main Menu
Parcels/Lots
Parcels are displayed in the graphics when you import a LandXML file. You can select the lines to get
basic information, and you can drill down into the Project Manager to see more details. The points that
define a Parcel are stored in the CgPoints section of the LandXML file. If you want to see the point
numbers on the screen, then you need to load the CgPoints. If you want to stake the points, then you
need to load the CgPoints into the Points DB.
Chains/Figures
These LandXML items may or may not appear, because a chain can cross from one CgPoints set to
another. This means that if you do not have all the CgPoint sets loaded, then the chains cannot
appear.
Import Template
Main Menu | Import / Export | CAD / LandXML Templates | Import Template
- 397 -
Stonex FieldGenius
If you have a template file saved you can import it back into your project. When you start the com-
mand you will see the file browse dialog that allows you to find and open the template file. After which
you will see the template import toolbar. If you need to create a template file, refer to the Template
Export topic.
- 398 -
Main Menu
Insert Template
Once you are satisfied with the location and rotation of the template, you can save it into the current
project by pressing the Insert button. New points and line work will be added to the project for you
automatically.
- 399 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Export Template
Main Menu | Import / Export | CAD / LandXML / Templates | Export Template
You can export and save line work (figures) and points to a file that can then be inserted into different
projects. An example of how this feature can be used is when you have a building that is common to
several projects. Instead of computing a new building in each project, you can do it just once, save it
to a file, then insert it into your other projects.
When you start the command you will see the template export toolbar.
There are four options available for selecting the line work and points.
Window All
This option lets you window the objects. All points and line work contained within the selection win-
dow will be accepted.
Window Points
This option lets you window objects, but only coordinate points will be selected all line work is
ignored.
Single All
Use this option to manually select objects in the map view to export. You can select points or lines /
arcs. If you select a line, the points that define the line will be exported as well.
Single Points
Use this option to select point one by one in the map screen.
- 400 -
Main Menu
Save Template
When you're done selecting your objects, you can save them to a file by pressing the Save button.
Choose a location for your template, give the file a descriptive name and save it. Template files have
a ".tpl" extension.
The different cut sheet formats will be described below. To create a cut sheet, select the desired cut
sheet format, then press the Create Report button, then choose the folder and filename for it. You
can give it any extension (one will not be automatically added) but we recommend using either .CSV
or .TXT. The extension you provide will not affect the contents of the file in any way.
If you've already created a cut sheet and want to open it to review it, press the Open Report button.
FieldGenius automatically creates a (.CSV) comma separated value file for each cut sheet format
you create. This file can be read into Excel, which will allow you to format it and print it. The records
stored during staking follow the RW5 format so cut sheet records can be created using software pack-
ages that support this format.
- 401 -
Stonex FieldGenius
LM80 Format: This option will format the cut sheet in the LM 80 format.
Offset Stakes Format
If you've staked points using the stake alignment command, you can create a cut sheet report for
your station and offset stakes.
- 402 -
Main Menu
Productivity Report
This type of report will display how many points were staked out in one day. Each day will be sep-
arated into its own column so users can track the daily productivity of the field crew.
Reference Line Report
This type of report will display horizontal and vertical offset information with regards to the design and
as-built point locations with regards to the referenced line used and the offset distance to the align-
ment.
- 403 -
Stonex FieldGenius
GIS Files
Shapefile Import
Main Menu | Import / Export | GIS Files | Shapefile Import
Imports a Shapefile and allows you to pick one attribute to associate with the shape.
Shapefile Export
Main Menu | Import / Export | GIS Files | Shapefile Export
Use this to export your points and linework in a shape file format. This can then be imported into
products that support shape files. This export will create a DBF, SHP and a SHX file for the linework
and points in your Project.
For example, if your Project name was FG Sample, the following files will be created for the linework.
FG Sample_POLYLINE.shx
FG Sample_POLYLINE.shp
FG Sample_POLYLINE.dbf
For the points in your Project, FieldGenius already stores points in a DBF file (FG Sample.dbf) so only
two other files will be created.
FG Sample.shx
- 404 -
Main Menu
FG Sample.shp
Importing into ESRI or other application
To open these files in a compatible product you need to ensure you have all six file saved in the same
directory.
For more information on shape files, visit www.esri.com
KML Export
Main Menu | Import / Export | GIS Files | KML Export
Exports a KML file of all the points measured with GNSS.
Coordinate Systems
Import / Export User Defined Coordinate Systems
Main Menu | Import / Export | Coordinate Systems | User Coordinate System Import
Main Menu | Import / Export | Coordinate Systems | User Coordinate System Export
User defined coordinate systems created by a user are saved in the binary mapping system files.
It is useful to be able to export these user created coordinate systems for the following reasons:
Import
You can import coordinate systems from a previously saved file.
When you import a file you will be asked to browse to and select the file you want to import. Once
selected, FieldGenius will check to make sure a user defined system doesn't already exist and if one
does, you will be asked if you want to skip importing it, or overwrite the existing coordinate system.
Export
When you export the user defined coordinate systems you will be able to specify a directory to save
the file to and a name for the file.
Exported files will automatically be saved with a CSMAP extension such as myco-
ordinatesystem.csmap.
All user defined coordinate systems in FieldGenius will be exported to the file.
- 405 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Backups
FieldGenius automatically creates a backup when you add or edit user defined coordinate systems. If
you forgot to save your user defined coordinate systems, you may be able to restore them using a
backup. Please see the Coordinate System topic for more details.
- 406 -
Main Menu
Points Database
Use this to open the points database. From here you will find numerous tools that can be used to edit
your points. Please see the Coordinate Database topic for more information.
Map Data Layers
Use this to import DXF, LandXML, and georeferenced raster image files into your Project, and to con-
trol the visibility of database layers and any files that you may have associated with your Project.
Please see the Map Data Layers topic for more information.
Surfaces
Use this to import DTM surface files into your Project, view and edit your DTM surfaces, and perform
volume calculations. Please see the Surfaces topic for more information.
Parcels (XML)
Use this to edit and view your XML parcels that are associated with your Project. Please see the Par-
cels (XML) topic for more information.
- 407 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Point Database
Main Menu | Data Manager | Point Database
The point database dialog is used to review, edit, and manipulate your point data in your Project data-
base. The list will display all points currently stored in the database, and the data can be sorted by
pressing the column headers.
The checked stake icon indicates points that have been staked
out.
- 408 -
Main Menu
The hub icon indicates control points, they cannot be edited under
any circumstances.
The user icon indicates user entered points, the coordinate can be
edited.
The stake and square icon indicates a Staked and Stored point.
The Staked and Stored survey role is unique and not associated
with LandXML schema.
Note:
To edit the coordinate of a measured or calculated point, you must first change its sur-
vey role to user entered.
Next/Previous
Use the green arrow button to display the next button sets for more options.
Edit
Use this to edit the coordinates of a point that is highlighted in the list using the Store/Edit Points tool.
Remember you must change the Survey Role to User Entered.
Delete
Use this to delete the current point or selection in the list. Note: There is no undelete point option in
FieldGenius. If you delete points from the coordinate database they cannot be restored without editing
and reprocessing your raw file.
Add
Use this to open the Store Point screen to manually enter a new point.
Find
Use this to select multiple points, based on a single point ID, a point ID range, a point coordinate
range, or point descriptions.
- 409 -
Stonex FieldGenius
RTS (Rotate/Translate/Scale)
Use this to rotate or translate your points that are currently selected in the coordinate list. When you
press the button you will see the Rotate / Translate / Scale Points screen. Please refer to the Rotate /
Translate / Scale topic for more information.
Local Transform
Use this to apply a coordinate transformation to a point or selection in the coordinate list. You need to
have calculated the transformation parameters prior to pressing this button. See the
Statistics
Use this to display statistics of the coordinate database, including the total number of points, bound-
ing minimum and maximum coordinate values, and point ID's in use, and point ID's not in use.
Map View
Use this to display the currently highlighted points on the screen.
Average
Press this button to enter the Point Averaging routine.
- 410 -
Main Menu
- 411 -
Stonex FieldGenius
User Data
FieldGenius uses the layer names specified in the AutoMap library to control the visibility of points
and figures by their description.
You can control the visibility of the entire database (both points and figures) by checking or uncheck-
ing the Database option under the User Data section of the tree. If the box is checked, then the data-
base is turned on and all of its layers will be visible; if unchecked, then the file and all of its layers is
turned off and it will not be visible. If the box has another smaller square inside it, this means that
some of its layers are turned on and other layers are turned off.
You can control the visibility of individual layers by expanding Database option under the User Data
section of the tree, and checking or unchecking the box beside the name of the layer. If the box is
checked, then the layer is turned on and entities on that layer will be visible; if unchecked, then the
layer is turned off and entities on it will not be visible.
When you close the Project, the layer status will be saved so that the next time the Project is opened,
the layer visibility will automatically be set the same as you had left it, so layers that were turned off
will remain turned off the next time the Project is opened up.
- 412 -
Main Menu
DXF Files
You can load multiple DXF files into your FieldGenius Project, and control the visibility of each of their
layers independently from the others.
You can control the visibility of the entire DXF file by checking or unchecking the box beside the
name of the DXF file, under the DXF Files section of the tree. If the box is checked, then the file is
turned on and all of its layers will be visible; if unchecked, then the file and all of its layers is turned off
and it will not be visible. If the box has another smaller square inside it, this means that some of its lay-
ers are turned on and other layers are turned off.
You can control the visibility of individual layers by expanding the name of the DXF file under the DXF
Files section of the tree, and checking or unchecking the box beside the name of the layer. If the box
is checked, then the layer is turned on and entities on that layer will be visible; if unchecked, then the
layer is turned off and entities on it will not be visible.
When you close the Project, the layer status will be saved so that the next time the Project is opened,
the layer visibility will automatically be set the same as you had left it, so files that were turned off will
remain turned off the next time the Project is opened up.
Add File
Press the Add File button to select a DXF file that you want to load into your Project. You will be able
to browse to and select any DXF file. Please see the Import DXF File topic for more information.
- 413 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Remove File
Highlight the DXF file that you want to remove from your Project, then press the Remove File button.
If a file is not highlighted, you will be reminded that a file must first be selected from the tree. This will
turn off all layers from the selected file in your FieldGenius Project and disassociate the DXF file. It
does not delete the DXF file.
File Settings
Highlight the DXF file that you wish to change the settings for, then press the File Settings button.
You can enable or disable the display of text in the selected file. If your DXF file contains text, turning
this off will improve performance of FieldGenius. Pressing the OK or Cancel buttons will return you to
the Layer Manager screen.
- 414 -
Main Menu
LandXML Files
You can load one LandXML file into your FieldGenius Project at a time, and control the visibility of its
layers (points, chains, alignments, and parcels).
You can control the visibility of the entire XML file by checking or unchecking the name of the XML
file, under the LXML Files section of the tree. If the box is checked, then the file is turned on and all of
its contents will be visible; if unchecked, then the file and all of its layers is turned off and it will not be
visible. If the box has another smaller square inside it, this means that some of its layers are turned
on and other layers are turned off.
You can control the visibility of individual layers by expanding the name of the XML file under the
LXML Files section of the tree, and checking or unchecking the box beside the name of the layer. If
the box is checked, then the layer is turned on and entities on that layer will be visible; if unchecked,
then the layer is turned off and entities on it will not be visible.
When you close the Project, the layer status will be saved so that the next time the Project is opened,
the layer visibility will automatically be set the same as you had left it, so layers that were turned off
will remain turned off the next time the Project is opened up.
Add File
Press the Add File button to select a LandXML file that you want to load into your Project. You will be
able to browse to and select any XML file. Please see the Import LandXML File topic for more inform-
ation. Note, you must first unload the currently loaded XML file before loading a different one.
- 415 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Remove File
Highlight the XML file that you want to remove from your Project, then press the Remove File button.
If a file is not highlighted, you will be reminded that a file must first be selected from the tree. This will
turn off all components of the selected file in your FieldGenius Project and disassociate the XML file.
It does not delete the XML file.
File Settings
The File Settings button does not apply to LandXML files.
Image Files
You can load georeferenced JPG or TIFF images into your FieldGenius Project, and control the vis-
ibility of the image.
You can control the visibility of your image by checking or unchecking the box beside the name of the
image file, under the Image Files section of the tree. If the box is checked, then the image is turned on
and it will be visible; if unchecked, then the image is turned off and it will not be visible.
When you close the Project, the visibility and opacity status of the image file will be saved so that the
next time the Project is opened, the image visibility will automatically be set the same as you had left
it.
- 416 -
Main Menu
Add File
Press the Add File button to select an image file to load into your Project. You will be able to browse
to and select any JPG or TIF file. JPG files must have a corresponding JGW world file, and TIF files
must have a corresponding TFW world file; these world files contain the georeferenced positioning
information. The world file must have the same file name as the image file (just with the appropriate
extension), and it will be automatically used to position the image. Note that the world file is unit-less,
make sure that the unit settings in the desktop and mobile software are the same.
Remove File
Highlight the image file you want to remove from your Project, then press the Remove File button. If a
file is not highlighted, you will be reminded that a file must first be selected from the tree. This will turn
off the selected image in your FieldGenius Project and disassociate the image file.
File Settings
Highlight the image file you want to view or change the display settings for, then press the File Set-
tings button. You will see the file's name, size, and position information. You can also adjust the opa-
city of the image. The default value of 100 will cause the image to be displayed normally, and
reducing this value will make it appear fainter on the screen. This is useful if the image file being dis-
played makes your other FieldGenius data too hard to see over top of the image. Pressing the Close
button will return you to the Layer Manager screen.
- 417 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Surfaces
Main Menu | Data Manager | Surfaces
View Toolbar | Surface Manager
FieldGenius allows you to display a 3D surface representation of the points and lines in your project.
This is done by turning on the Point Database surface.
- 418 -
Main Menu
To import a QSB file, use the Load button at the bottom of the Surface Manager screen. Please see
the DTM Surface File Import (QSB) topic for more information.
DTM Surface Manager
The surface called Point Database represents the real-time DTM Surface made up from points and
lines that are in your project. If you have imported any other surfaces from a QSB or LandXML file
they will also appear in this list.
To use a surface you first need to load it into memory by checking inside the box before the name of
the surface in the list. A surface is loaded if there is a checkmark shown before it. If you expand the
surface you can control whether it is drawn as Contour Lines, a wireframe TIN, a solid TIN, or any
combination of these.
Settings
Surface settings allow you to specify settings that affect the surfaces or contours that are drawn.
Please see the Surface Settings topic for more information.
Volumes
Use this button to calculate a volume. Please see the Volume Calculation topic for more information.
Load
Use this button to load a .QSB surface file into your project. Please see the Import DTM Surface File
topic for more information.
- 419 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Save
Use this button to save the selected surface as a .QSB file which can be imported into your Stonex
Geomatics CAD desktop software or into another FieldGenius project.
Close
If you close the surfaces screen and return back to the map screen you will see the loaded surface
drawn as a wireframe, solid, and/or with contours depending on what is set in the Settings screen.
Surface Information
You can see additional statistics about the surface by double clicking on its name in the list. This will
show the minimum and maximum bounding coordinates, the number of points, breaklines, and tri-
angles in the surface, the minimum and maximum slopes in the surface, the plan and surface area,
the positive and negative volumes calculated from a datum elevation of 0, and the amount of memory
that the surface is using.
- 420 -
Main Menu
Surface Settings
Main Menu | Data Manager | Surfaces | Settings
View Toolbar | Surface Manager | Settings
Use the surface settings screen to define settings that affect TIN (Triangular Irregular Network),
TGRID and Contours.
Contour Interval
This will force the contours to be drawn at an interval equal to the value set here. The interval is equal
to the drawing units.
Minimum Elevation
This controls the minimum elevation. This is useful if you have some data that is displayed at a zero
elevation (example: alignment point data that is horizontal) and you want to exclude these points from
the surface.
Limit TIN Side
This will determine the max length that will be allowed for a TIN triangle.
Gridded TIN
If this is on, when you draw the surface it will be represented using a TGRID model instead of a TIN
model. TGRID surfaces will apply smoothing in areas that have no breaklines. This may create better
quality contours. The Grid Size is a ground unit value that will determine the spacing of the grid lines.
If the Grid Size is 0 then a grid size will be automatically calculated.
- 421 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Volume Calculation
Main Menu | Data Manager | Surfaces | Volumes
View Toolbar | Surface Manager | Volumes
FieldGenius allows you to calculate the volume between a surface and either another surface or a
datum elevation. The volume can be computed for the entire surface, or it can be bound by a closed
figure.
- 422 -
Main Menu
Calculated Surface
Choose the surface that you want to calculate the volumes for. If you have imported any surfaces
from a QSB or LandXML file they will be available to choose from, or you can choose the real-time
Point Database surface.
Reference Surface
You can choose have the volume calculated between your selected surface and either a datum elev-
ation (which defaults at 0 meters/feet), or if you have imported any surfaces from a QSB or LandXML
file they will be available to choose as a reference surface.
Constrain volume calculation within area
If this is unchecked, a surface volume calculation will be computed for the entire surface. If this is
checked, an area volume calculation will be computed for a portion of the surface bounded by an area
you define. You can press the Define Area button to select a closed figure to assign as a boundary
for the volume calculation. After you have selected the figure, press Close to return to the Volumes
Calculation screen.
Calculate
Pressing this will calculate and display the positive, negative and net volumes, the average thick-
ness, and the area of the surface from either the selected datum elevation or reference surface, all
constrained within the selected closed figure if selected.
- 423 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The results will also be written into the project's CogoCalcs.txt history file which can be viewed by
going to Main Menu | Survey Tools | COGO History Viewer.
- 424 -
Main Menu
From Main Menu | Data Manager | Surfaces you can turn on the Realtime DTM Surface by placing a
checkmark in the box before the "Point Database" surface. Expanding the tree will allow you to define
whether it is displayed as Contour Lines, Solid Faces, and/or Triangle Edges.
The surface can be viewed or used in volume computations immediately.
Before turning on the Point Database surface:
Each point in the database has an attribute called "DTM State". This can be set to "Do not Include". If
you set a point to this value, you will see that the surface no longer includes this point. This only
applies to the current surface that is computed in FieldGenius. It does not apply to surfaces imported
from a QSB or LandXML file.
What is the difference between a TIN and a TGRID?
The user should become familiar with both options and decide which option is best suited for their pro-
ject.
TIN honors breaklines but may be too restrictive for contours to follow the natural flow of the terrain.
Contours around small hills may look jagged if too few data points were collected.
- 425 -
Stonex FieldGenius
TGRD honors breaklines and allows the contours to follow the natural flow of the terrain. Contours
around small hills will look better if the TGRD option is used.
Generally, the TGRDis for cases where you want curvature introduced between your data points and
you have breaklines. This is most easily shown with an example:
- 426 -
Main Menu
This line represents a location at the site where the slope changes from a steep hill to a relatively flat
area.
Contours Generated without use of Top of Bank breakline:
- 427 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Without a breakline, the contours "flow" over the top of the bank and the contours do not look correct.
Contours generated with use of Top of Bank breakline:
With a breakline, the contours are forced to honor the line, as a change in slope that helps the con-
tours to look correct.
Breakline Control
The user would want to use a figure as a breakline in the triangle formation process (TIN) for the edge
of pavement, but probably not for a line connecting points that are not related to the surface features.
An example of this might be a chain connecting legal boundaries as they might cross over roads or
creeks without consideration for the existing topography.
- 428 -
Main Menu
Breaklines are used in the creation of the DTM by forcing the triangulation to follow them. Triangles
created in the DTM cannot cross a breakline. The edges of the triangles will always follow the break-
line. When necessary, FieldGenius will automatically densify the DTM along the breakline to create
triangles that conform to the breaklines. This helps with the creation of accurate surface models and
contours. FieldGenius contains the exact same functions for surface modeling, contouring, and
volumes as Stonex Geomatics CAD.
Contouring
Creating contours in FieldGenius is a simple as choosing the desired DTM surface from the dialog
and checking the contour option:
The procedures for contouring a DTM surface are outlined below:
- 429 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Function
1. Open the Surface Manager, then press the Load button.
2. Browse to where your DTM surface file (.QSB) is located and press the Open button to con-
tinue.
3. You will now see the surface list screen. From here you can turn on your layer and configure
DTM settings. Please see the Surface Sets topic for more information.
Store
If you highlight a parcel in the list, pressing the Store button will compute and store coordinates at the
corners of your parcel.
- 430 -
Main Menu
Stake
If you press this it will open the line staking toolbar. Note: you have to press close to exit the parcel
manager.
- 431 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Roads Manager
Main Menu | Roads Manager
To stake an alignment you first need to define the geometry that defines the horizontal and vertical ele-
ment. You can also define a template that will be used to define cross sections at specific stations
along the alignment.
FieldGenius can use the following three methods to define an alignment.
1. Manual Entry – You can manually enter the data to define the alignment.
2. Import XML – You can import a LandXML file that contains your alignment data.
By default you will see an alignment in the list with the current project name. A project can contain
multiple roads, and each road can contain the following elements.
l Horizontal Element: This can contain straight tangents, curves and spirals.
l Vertical Element: This can contain grade breaks, parabolic curves and non-symmetrical
curves.
l Templates: Template can contain horizontal and vertical offsets, as well as widening and
super elevation data.
l XML Cross Sections: XML cross sections define specific stations along an alignment. These
sections contain horizontal, vertical and template data. XML cross sections are created using
desktop software which is then imported into FieldGenius.
- 432 -
Main Menu
Manage Road
This option is only available once you've created a road using the New Road button or imported an
XML file. To input or review alignment data, press the Manage Road button to access the Road Set-
tings screen.
If you imported a LandXML file, or manually inputted a road you can stake it by pressing this button.
As a minimum you need to have the following before the stake command will continue.
Add Road
Use this button to create a new road. You can create as many roads as needed and they will be
stored in an XML file that will reside is the project directory.
Delete Road
Use this to delete a road. You first need to highlight the road you want to delete, and then press the
button to remove the road from the alignment. This road will be permanently deleted and cannot be
undone.
Map View
Use this button to display the map view. From this view you can use the zoom controls to zoom
around your drawing so you can find important or relevant data for your alignment such as a POB
point. Press the Close View button to return back to the Roads Manager.
- 433 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Manage Road
The road settings screen is used to help you create, review or modify road elements.
- 434 -
Main Menu
- 435 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The C/L Editor can display a view of the map along the bottom. This view can be toggled on and off by
pressing the Show Map/Hide Map button.
If you would like to zoom into or pan around the map, press the Map View button which will display
zoom and pan controls. Press the Close View button when you want to return the C/L Editor.
Adding an Element
To add an element to a road you need to use the Add Element button. Once you press this you will
see 5 options appear that will help you define the different elements supported by FieldGenius.
l Line (Tangent)
l Curve
l Spiral
l Spiral-Curve-Spiral
l Chain
Tip: When you're prompted for a distance or direction, you can always use the distance and direction
recall features just like you would for COGO calculations.
Line (Tangent) Element
In the Line Element editor, gray fields indicate fields that cannot be edited. All other non gray fields
can be edited by the user. When you enter your known values and have confirmed their correctness,
press OK to save these values, or press Cancel to exit without saving.
- 436 -
Main Menu
A tangent is defined by a direction and length. There are four ways you can define the tangent and
they are explained in further detail below.
- 437 -
Stonex FieldGenius
1. You always have to define the direction for the curve, either right or left.
2. Enter your know values.
3. You don't have to specify the PC point, the function will assume that you're beginning at the
end of the last leg.
4. A PC Tangent direction will automatically be computed based on the previous tangent. You
can always over ride this value if you need to define a non-tangent curve.
5. Press OK to save your inputted values, Cancel to exit without saving.
Spiral Element
When you select this option your will see the spiral editor. This will help you define a spiral segment
for your alignment.
- 438 -
Main Menu
l Spiral Direction
l End Radius
l Spiral Length
In the editor, gray fields indicate fields that cannot be edited. All other non gray fields can be edited by
the user.
Press OK to save your inputted values, Cancel to exit without saving.
- 439 -
Stonex FieldGenius
l Spiral Direction
l Spiral In Length
l Spiral Out Length
l Curve Radius
l Curve Length
In the editor, gray fields indicate fields that cannot be edited. All other non gray fields can be edited by
the user.
Press OK to save your inputted values, Cancel to exit without saving.
Chain
Use this option if you want to select points or figures in your drawing to define the centerline and the
profile (optional).
When you select the Add Figure option you will be taken to the map screen where you can select a
figure.
You can also add points individually by using the Add Points(s) button.
Press OK to save the chain, press Cancel to exit without saving.
- 440 -
Main Menu
Note:
You should only select Tangent sections for a Chain. If you Add a Figure which con-
tains arcs or splines, the chain will straight-line any curved segments, so the resulting
Chain length and stationing will not be the same as the original Figure.
Chain Element
When you return to the road editor you will see that a chain element has been created. Chain ele-
ments differ from regular elements in that even though a chain can be made up of line and curve ele-
ments, it will appear in the list as a chain.
Auto Profile
After you press OK, you will be asked if you would like to create a vertical profile based on the chain
point's elevation. If you select Yes, then you will be prompted for a Profile Name.
Vertical Profile
As mentioned above, a vertical profile can optionally be created automatically. If this option is chosen
by the user, PVI points will be created for the profile. Each PVI point represents the points that make
up the chain.
- 441 -
Stonex FieldGenius
l PVI
l Parabolic Curve
l Unsymmetric Parabolic Curve
l Circular Curve
Once created, you can always edit and delete each element.
- 442 -
Main Menu
Station Check
Use this button to calculate an elevation along your vertical profile at the station you define. In the
example below you will see the station entered was 0+150, and the computed elevation is 382.750.
The station check button can be used with all vertical element types.
- 443 -
Stonex FieldGenius
In the example above you can see that the high and low points are listed in the grid. This option can be
used to display the high / low information for all vertical profile elements.
PVI Element
PVI elements are essentially straight grade segments that change direction at grade breaks. Each
grade break (PVI) has to be defined by a station and elevation.
- 444 -
Main Menu
When you select to add a PVI element you will have two fields available where the station and the
elevation at that station can be entered. Once you have a minimum of two PVI points, the slope of the
line will be displayed.
- 445 -
Stonex FieldGenius
In the example you will see that a PVI was established for the beginning of the vertical profile. Then
the PVI for the vertical curve was defined, as well as another parabolic curve. You will also notice that
if you click a Para element, its location will be displayed in the display area.
Station Check
You can also do a station check on a parabolic vertical curve. Simply press the Sta Check button and
enter the station you would like to compute an elevation for.
High / Low Calculation
With all vertical curves, the high or low point can be computed. For example, if we use the High/Low
button to compute this information you will see the high point is at station 0+154.167 at an elevation of
382.761m.
- 446 -
Main Menu
- 447 -
Stonex FieldGenius
In the example you will see that a PVI was established for the beginning of the vertical profile. Then
the PVI for the unsymmetrical vertical curve was defined, as well as another PVI element. You will
also notice that if you click an Unsym element, its location will be displayed in the display area.
Station Check
You can also do a station check on an unsymmetrical vertical curve. Simply press the Sta Check but-
ton and enter the station you would like to compute an elevation for.
High / Low Calculation
With all vertical curves, the high or low point can be computed. For example, if we use the High/Low
button to compute this information you will see the High point is at station 0+233.333 at an elevation
of 382.786m.
- 448 -
Main Menu
Circular Curve
This option allows you to enter an equal tangent vertical circular curve. At a minimum you need to
know the PVI Station, PVI Elevation, and Curve Radius for your vertical curve. Furthermore if this
is a new profile you need to define a PVI point before the vertical curve, as well as define a PVI, Para-
bolic, or circular after the vertical curve. Elements are needed before and after the vertical curve ele-
ment so the profile editor can calculate the tangents.
- 449 -
Stonex FieldGenius
In the example you will see that a PVI was established for the beginning of the vertical profile. Then
the first vertical circular curve was defined, as well as two more circular curve elements after and to
finish it off, a final PVI is needed. You will also notice that if you click a circular curve element, its loc-
ation will be displayed in the display area.
Station Check
You can also do a station check on a vertical circular curve. Simply press the Station Check button
and enter the station you would like to compute an elevation for.
High / Low Calculation
With all vertical circular curves, the high or low point can be computed. For example, if we use the
High/Low button to compute this information you will see the High point is at station 0+164.199 at an
elevation of 2.661m.
- 450 -
Main Menu
- 451 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Add Zones
Many software programs refer to templates as having segments, in FieldGenius they are referred to
as zones. Zones contain horizontal and vertical components, and these zones are located on the right
or left of the template centerline.
You first need to define what side of the centerline your zone belongs to: Left or Right.
Once you do that you can choose the Add Zone command from the Commands button.
When you select the add zone command you will see your first zone item appear in the grid area. You
need to enter a horizontal width distance and then specify how you will be defining the slope for the
zone. The slope for the zone can be defined by entering a slope value (%) or a vertical distance also
referred to as a delta Z. In the example shown below you will see that three zones have been defined
for the left side of the template.
By default all new zones are attached to the zone found furthest from the centerline.
- 452 -
Main Menu
Delete Zones
Any zone that is highlighted in the zone list can be deleted by using the Delete Zone command.
There is no undo, so be careful when you use this command.
Clear All
At any time, you can clear the zone list so you can start over. To do this use the Clear Zone com-
mand. There is no undo, so be careful when you use this command.
Mirror Zones
There are two variations of this command. You can mirror your zones from left to right, or right to left.
In our example from above, when the Mirror Left to Right command is used, the zones are duplic-
ated on the right side of the template.
- 453 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Note: Depending on what side you're displaying, you will only see the zones listed for that side of the
template. To see the zones for the other side you need to change to the opposite side using the Left
Zone and Right Zone buttons.
Move Zone
Zones can be shifted around by moving them in or out form the centerline. To do this, use the Move In
and Move Out commands.
View Zone Modifiers
The template you define is a typical cross section for the entire alignment. You can define changes to
the template at specific stations and these changes are referred to as Zone Modifiers. Zone mod-
ifiers modify the typical template to allow for deviations such as road widening and super elevations.
This tool is meant to be used when you've defined zone modifiers. Please see the advanced template
editing for more information.
Advanced Zone Edit
Advanced editing of your zones is available to give you even more power and flexibility. Being able to
modify the zones at specific stations, allow you to create template transitions, widenings and super-
elevation transitions.
You first need to highlight the zone you want to modify in the zone list. Once you do that press the
Advanced Zone Edit… command. This will then display the zone editor for the zone you've selec-
ted, in this example it is zone 3.
- 454 -
Main Menu
By default when you create a zone, the width, delta elevation and slope are used from the beginning
of the zone to the end. The start and end stations are determined by start and end station defined in
the horizontal alignment.
Slopes Modifier
When you use this button you will see the slope modifier page. On this page you can define different
modifiers that change the slope or delta Z value for the zone.
Cut/Fill Modifier
When you use this button you will see the cut/fill modifier page. On this page you can define different
modifiers that change the cut / fill value for the zone.
Note: This function is currently not implemented fully and is reserved for a future version.
Cut/Fill Slope values from the hinge point can be set in the Options screen.
Widths Modifier
When you use this button you will see the widths modifier page. On this page you can define different
modifiers that change the width value for the zone.
- 455 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The original zone 3 has a constant elevation and width from beginning to end, but we want to modify it
to include a section that has a slope and width difference.
The new zone 3 will look like the following example. From station 6+00 to 7+00 the width of the zone
transitions from a width of 5' to 10' and the elevation transitions from 0 down to -2'. Then from station
8+00 to 9+-00 it transitions back to the normal width and grade.
Slope Modifier
First you need to highlight the zone that you want to add modifiers to.
Then select the Advanced Zone Edit command from the commands button. This will open the zone
modifier screen for the zone. In our example, we'll be modifying zone 3 on the left side of the tem-
plate.
To add slope modifiers, press the Slopes (#) button. From here you can press the Add button to add
modifiers for the zone. The following table shows the information that would have been inputted.
- 456 -
Main Menu
You have to define if you are entering a relative vertical change, or want FieldGenius to compute it for
you using a slope percent and horizontal distance for the zone. You can do this by selecting the Vert
Type and set it to Vertical Distance or Slope.
- 457 -
Stonex FieldGenius
If we check station 7+00 you will see that the zone now extends further and drops down.
- 458 -
Main Menu
Labels A to F show the stations where we will be adding modifiers to modify the template so the road
transitions from normal crown to full superelevation and back. Note: In this example the super-
elevation is exaggerated for ease of viewing.
Slope Modifier
First you need to highlight the zone that you want to add modifiers to.
Then select the Advanced Zone Edit command from the commands button. This will open the zone
modifier screen for the zone. In our example, we'll be modifying zone 3 on the left side of the tem-
plate.
To add slope modifiers, press the Slopes (#) button. From here you can press the Add button to add
modifiers for the zone. The following table shows the information that would have been inputted.
- 459 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 460 -
Main Menu
If we check station 10+78.54 you will see that we are at the full superelevation section.
- 461 -
Stonex FieldGenius
If you import a LandXML file that has cross sections in it, you can immediately go to the Roads Man-
ager and select the road to stake. You will see the roads in the Cross-Sections list. Choose one, then
press the Stake Roads button you will see the stake Alignment screen.
Please see the Stake Alignment section for more information about using this command.
- 462 -
Main Menu
- 463 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Use the Stake Road button to start the road staking which will display the Stake Alignment screen.
- 464 -
Main Menu
Stake Station
You can also manually enter the station you would like to stake by entering it in the Station field.
Design Offsets
Move Along Template
You can move along the template by using the Left and Right buttons. As you do this the offset from
the centerline will be displayed in the Offset field. Furthermore you will see what side of the template
you're on by looking at the direction field. You will also note in the template preview, the "x" visually
marks the design offset.
Define an Offset
You can define your own offset to stake by entering the value in the Offset field. To enter a Left offset,
use a negative value.
- 465 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 466 -
Main Menu
You will note that when a setback or stake offset is defined, you will see an orange circle in the pre-
view screen. This circle indicates the location of the setback.
Note: If you want to make sure that you're staking nothing but design points along the template, then
make sure the Setback field is equal to 0.0.
Elevation and Vertical Offset
Elevation
The field will show you the computed elevation on the template at the design offset specified. This
value can be changed to allow you stake a different elevation.
Vertical Offset
This field works in conjunction with the elevation field. If the user enters a different elevation than the
one that was computed on the template, the difference between the elevations is shown in the ver-
tical offset field.
If you know what the vertical offset is for the point you're staking on the template, you can enter it in
this field. You will see the elevation for the point update to reflect the offset you defined.
- 467 -
Stonex FieldGenius
In the template preview screen you will see an orange circle. This circle indicates the location of the
vertical offset point that will be staked.
Note: If you want to make sure that you're staking nothing but design points along the template, then
make sure the Setback field is equal to 0.0.
Template Preview
You can zoom into your template using the zoom controls. You can also pan the template by tapping
on it and dragging it on the screen.
Use the Map button to display the location of the template along you alignment. This will be displayed
in the map view window.
Stake Offset
Once you've defined that point you want to stake, you can select the Stake Offset button to start the
staking process. When you press this button you will see the staking toolbar. For an explanation of
the staking toolbar and alignment staking, please refer to the next section, Alignment Staking - Part 2.
Stake Slope
This is the Stake Slope toggle. Normally you will slope stake from the hinge point on the template,
but it is totally up to you. The slope staking feature can be used from any point on the template.
Road Settings
Press this button to return to the road settings screen.
- 468 -
Main Menu
When you press the Stake Road button you will see the Stake Alignment screen which is described
in detail above.
Stake Alignment with a Reference Line
To stake to an Alignment using a Reference Line the user needs to first import in a XML file containing
an alignment then a DXF file is needed for the Reference Line information. Use the Importer feature
found in the main menu to bring in both data files.
- 469 -
Stonex FieldGenius
After this is completed go into the Roads Manager to select which road alignment to use. Continue by
pressing the Manage Road button to take you to the Road Settings page. The Alignment info should
be updated and reflect a valid Start Station and Alignment C/L length. From here the user must define
a line by pressing the Select Reference Line button at the bottom of the list of settings.
By pressing this it will take the user to the Map View where you can navigate around the screen to
select the appropriate DXF linework to be used in as the Reference Line in the routine. Once selected
press the OK button to take you back to the Road Settings page where the label for that line will now
be displayed.
Press the Stake Road button if you are satisfied with the selected road alignment and reference line
to proceed to the Stake Reference Line setup page.
- 470 -
Main Menu
From the Stake Reference Line dialog the user can customize the features work flow by the following
settings;
Alignment Station
In this section the user has the ability to set which Station location to start at and the interval distance
to use when proceeding to the next station. There are additional settings to further control the moving
from one station to another.
The AUTO check box when check ON will automatically move up the next station interval by either
incremental or decremental along the alignment after a point has been stored.
The Include Element Transition Points check box when checked ON will stop at the next vertical and
horizontal deflection point along the alignment. This will ignore the station interval value to ensure a
key transition point is not skipped over.
Reference Line Offsets
Here the user can enter in a Horizontal and Vertical offset value. This offset will be calculated from
the point on the referenced line. An interval can also be applied here manually for the horizontal offset
value.
When you are satisfied with the values entered press the Stake Reference Line button to continue to
the Stake Point screen. After a point has been successfully staked out and stored the routine will go
back to the Stake Reference Line window. Alternatively pressing the Cancel if you wish to back out
to the Map View screen.
- 471 -
Stonex FieldGenius
From the stake alignment screen, when you press the Stake Offset button if you are staking with a
robotic instrument or GNSS you will immediately see the staking toolbar. If you are staking with a con-
ventional instrument you will see the turn-to information first, directing you to the design point.
- 472 -
Main Menu
The alignment offset staking process is very similar to normal point staking. What is different is you
will see the station/offset information about where the prism is in relation to the alignment and more
importantly, to the point you're staking.
Staking Method
Turn an Angle: You will see the horizontal angles to the design point and to your actual meas-
urement. This is useful for getting online (left/right) with a conventional total station.
Directional: You will see the move distances (In/Out/Left/Right or N/S/E/W, as well as Cut/Fill) guid-
ing you from the actual measurement to the design point.
Radial: You will see a direction and distance guiding you from the actual measurement to the design
point.
Stationing - Absolute: You will see the offset of the actual measurement along the alignment.
Stationing - Relative: You will see the move distances guiding you along the alignment from the
actual measurement to the design point.
Staking Information
The station/offset of the design point is indicated directly on the staking toolbar, and also in the
Staking Information screen which you can access by pressing the Info button in the staking toolbar.
The station/offset of the actual measurement is available in the Staking Information screen.
- 473 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The move or rotate information which will guide you from the actual measurement to the design
point is indicated in the observation toolbar. You can press the Page button to toggle between various
information if you do not see these values. If your measurement is within your defined tolerance of the
design point then the text will be green, if not then the text will be red. This information is also avail-
able in the Staking Information screen. The type of information shown will vary based on your current
Staking Method.
Template Preview
At any time during your staking you can press the Profile button to see the actual
rod position which will be shows as an orange circle, in relation to the template
defined for the alignment.
- 474 -
Main Menu
Zoom Stake
If you press the Zoom Stake button in the staking toolbar, you will be zoomed in to show you both the
design point and the actual measurement. The green circular area surrounding the design point
reflects the area where you are within the defined staking tolerances.
- 475 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Store Point
When you are ready to store the stake point press the Store Point button. You will then see the res-
ults for your stakeout.
If you are using GNSS to stake the alignment, then you will not see the Store Point button. Instead,
press the Measure button to trigger a measurement and then store the resulting shot.
Press Save Point and Raw Data to store a point for this shot and to write your stake and cut sheet
records to the raw file. By default the description for the stored stake point will equal the station and
offset that was being staked.
Press Save Raw Data to write your stake and cut sheet records to the raw file, without storing a
point.
If you press Cancel, nothing is stored or written to the raw file.
Records written to raw file
Following are the records that are written to the raw file when you store a point.
If you do not store a point then the SP (Store Point) record is not recorded as no point was stored in
the database.
SP,PN4,N 20000.0068,E 5000.0099,EL100.1038,--0+00.00 C 0.000
CF,ST0.000,OD1,OL0.010,EL100.1038,GD100.0000
OE,ST0.000,OE0.010
DE,PN,N 20000.000,E 5000.000,EL100.000,--
SD,ND-0.007,ED-0.010,LD-0.104
SK,OP1,FP4,AR201.48000,ZE93.10000,SD269.6600,--0+00.00 C 0.000
- 476 -
Main Menu
When you start slope staking and you measure your first shot, the program computes an intersection
between a horizontal plane containing the measurement and the slope defined in the stake settings
from the hinge point. FieldGenius will then compute a best guess location for the catch point and will
tell you how much you need to move. After you measure a second shot, FieldGenius will create an
imaginary line between the two shots and intersects the slope from the hinge point. It then computes
a new solution for the catch point.
- 477 -
Stonex FieldGenius
At any time during your staking you can press the Profile button to see the actual
rod position which will be shows as an orange circle. You will also see the slope
lines from the hinge point.
When you get near the catch point if you press the Zoom Stake button you will see a green circle in
the map view representing the area within your specified staking tolerances.
- 478 -
Main Menu
Cut or Fill Slope: The first line will always tell you if you staked a cut slope or fill slope. It will also
display the design slope that was specified and record the actual computed slope that was staked.
- 479 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Station: This will display the station of the template or cross section, and will show the actual station
staked at the catch point.
Hinge Point: This is the distance from the rod position to the hinge point. It will also indicate the ver-
tical distance from rod position to the hinge point. A cut indicates that the hinge point is lower; fill indic-
ates that it is higher than the current rod position.
Center Line: This is the distance from the rod position to the centerline. It will also indicate the ver-
tical distance from rod position to the centerline. A cut indicates that the centerline is lower; fill indic-
ates that it is higher than the current rod position.
Save Shot
Press Save Point and Raw Data store a point for this shot and to write your stake and cut sheet
records to the raw file. By default the description for the stored stake point will equal the station and
offset that was being slope staked. An example of an auto generated description is CP 4+00.00 R
22.000. The CP stands for Catch Point.
Press Save Raw Data to write your stake and cut sheet records to the raw file, without storing a
point.
If you press Cancel, nothing is stored or written to the raw file.
Records written to raw file
Following are the records that are written to the raw file when you store a point.
If you do not store the staked point, the SP (Store Point) record will not be recorded as no point was
stored in the database.
SP,PN81,N 5002.9770,E 4997.8367,EL99.9829,--CP 0+12.00 L 1.000
SL,ST12.000,OD2,EL99.983,GD99.983,AS0.005,HH0.985,VH0.966,HC1.985,VC0.966,-
CF0,DS1.000000,OB1.019583
SK,OP100,FP81,AR282.28000,ZE90.16000,SD3.6800,--CP 0+12.00 L 1.000
- 480 -
Main Menu
Now on the staking toolbar you will see the word Stk: Pnt CP Setback which indicates you're cur-
rently staking a slope stake setback point.
When you get to the offset position and store the point you will see the results screen once again.
This time, the offsets to the hinge point and centerline will include the offset distance.
- 481 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The vertical distances that are reported on the results screen are not computed using the cur-
rent rod position. These values will be in relation to the actual catch point that was staked.
When you store the point you will see that the description that is auto generated for the point will be
similar to the following example. REF CP 4+00.00 R 24.00
Records written to raw file
Following are the records that are written to the raw file when you store a point.
- 482 -
Main Menu
If you have the Store Staked Point toggle turned off in the stake settings screen, you will see that no
SP record is recorded as no point was stored in the database.
SP,PN5004,N 5007.7522,E 5001.5139,EL100.1445,--CP 0+06.00 L 1.000
SL,ST6.000,OD2,EL100.144,GD100.144,AS-
0.002,HH0.498,VH0.501,HC1.498,VC0.501,CF0,DS1.000000,OB0.994169
SK,OP101,FP5004,AR353.45220,ZE90.23420,SD13.9200,--CP 0+06.00 L 1.000
SP,PN82,N 5007.2194,E 5002.2307,EL102.2842,--REF CP 0+06.00 L 2.000
SR,ST6.000,OD2,EL102.284,GD100.144,AS-
0.002,HH2.390,VH0.501,HC2.387,VC0.501,CF0,DS1.000000,OB0.994169,OL1.000
DE,PNCP Setback,N 5007.078,E 5002.253,EL100.144,--
SD,ND-0.141,ED0.022,LD-2.140
SK,OP101,FP82,AR351.10340,ZE82.00000,SD14.6850,--REF CP 0+06.00 L 2.000
- 483 -
Total Station Reference
- 484 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Target Manager
This allows you to create, copy, and delete targets in FieldGenius. You can define a unique backsight
and foresight target for example. See the Target Managertopic for more information.
EDM Settings
This allows you to specify if you will be using prism offsets in FieldGenius and allows you to specify
tolerances that will be used to ensure your EDM measurement meet your criteria. See the EDM Set-
tings topic for more information.
Tolerance Settings
This allows you to specify angular distance tolerances that will be used by the traverse routines. See
the Measurement Tolerance topic for more information.
Search Settings
When using a robotic instrument, you can specify search window parameters. See the Search Set-
tings topic for more information.
- 485 -
Total Station Reference
Please note that not all Bluetooth-enabled devices will list Bluetooth as a Port option.
In some cases you must configure and use a virtual COM port through Windows CE's
internal Bluetooth Settings, for example COM6.
- 486 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Bluetooth Search
If you set the port to Bluetooth, a Bluetooth Search button will appear. Press the search button to
find the device you want to communicate wirelessly with. All devices within range will be listed,
choose the one you want to use
The device you selected will be saved into your instrument profile for future use so you do not need to
Search every time.
Bluetooth PIN
After initiating a Bluetooth connection, you will be prompted to enter the PIN (passkey) for the instru-
ment you are connecting to. If your instrument does not need one just leave it blank and continue by
pressing OK.
The PIN you enter will be encrypted and stored in your instrument profile.
RC Port
If you are connecting with a Topcon Robot, you can specify which port on your data collector the RC
unit is connected to.
Radio Settings
Use this to set the communication parameters for your radios or other communication device, such
as the channel or frequency. You can also use it to specify a direct connection to FieldGenius instead
of using radios. Please see the Radio Settings topic for additional information.
Connect
Use this to connect to your instrument after you have specified your communication settings.
If you see the following message, "No communication with instrument. Check settings, cables and
power." read the No Communication topic for possible causes.
FieldGenius connects successfully, the Status will change to "Connected", and if your instrument
supports graphical representation of the level bubble, you will see the Check Level screen.
Radio Configuration
Main Menu | Connect | Edit Total Station Profile | Model and Communication | Radio Settings
Use this to specify if you want to connect to your robotic instrument using a direct connection or
through the instrument's radios. If you're using a Topcon, you can specify your RC unit as the com-
munication device and assign a COM port for it. Press the Radio Settings to bring up the options for
what type of radio you are using to connect to the Topcon instrument.
- 487 -
Total Station Reference
Connection
Direct
This will allow you to connect directly to your instrument through an instrument cable.
Radio
This will allow you to connect to your instrument using external radios. Select your radio channel, if
this option is available.
- 488 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Note: If you are using radios with your instrument but this option is disabled or not available, then pick
the Direct option instead.
RC
This will allow FieldGenius and your instrument to communicate through the RC unit.
EDM Settings
Main Menu | Connect | Edit Total Station Profile | EDM Settings
Total Station Toolbar | Instrument Settings | EDM Settings
From here you can specify EDM settings such as prism offsets and measurement modes.
EDM Settings
Time Out (s)
Use this to specify the length of time FieldGenius will try to receive a measurement from your instru-
ment. You may need to set this to a higher number if you're trying to receive measurement in wooded
areas or long sights.
Use Default Time Out
If this is checked on FieldGenius will use a default time out value. If you would like to change it you
need to uncheck it and update the Time Out field.
- 489 -
Total Station Reference
Measurement Tolerance
Main Menu | Connect | Edit Total Station Profile | Tolerance Settings
Total Station Toolbar | Instrument Settings | Tolerance Settings
Use this to set tolerances that are used when you're using the multi-set collection function in
FieldGenius.
- 490 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Search Settings
Main Menu | Connect | Edit Total Station Profile | Search Settings
Total Station Toolbar | Instrument Settings | Search Settings
When using a robotic or motorized instrument you can specify search settings for your instrument.
Search Modes
Some of FieldGenius's search modes are common to all robotic instruments, but there are a few
model specific ones. The modes available are:
- 491 -
Total Station Reference
Relative Window
This allows you to specify a "window" defined by measuring a point at the top right and bottom left
corners. If you press the search button, the search limits will be relative to the direction the instrument
is currently pointing. In other words if your search window ranges are 30° horizontal and 30° vertical,
it will apply this to your current direction. So the search will be limited to an area 15° left, right, up and
down from your current direction.
Absolute Window
This allows you to specify an absolute search "center" for your search window. This forces
FieldGenius to search in an absolute area defined by the angles set in the search window center
fields. Furthermore, the search window range parameters apply to the search window center. For
example, let's assume you defined 180° as the horizontal search window center, and the horizontal
search window range is 30°. Your instrument will be forced to search in an area 15° left and right of the
180° plate reading. So if your prism is situated at a circle reading of 210°, it would never find you as
the instrument would never go past a circle reading of 195° (180+15) when searching.
RC-2 Fast Track
If you're using a Topcon instrument, you can set the search mode to RC-2. This will force the instru-
ment to use the RC-2 system for the search.
PS Next
This setting will appear if your Leica instrument has the power search system. Using this setting with
FieldGenius onboard will operate the new directional Power Search function relative to the prism.
Pressing the PS button on the right side will force the instrument to start its search turning to the right.
If FieldGenius is being operated via a Data Collector and this setting is used the functions will be rel-
ative to the Instrument. So pressing the PS button on the right side will force the instrument to turn to
the left.
PS Next (Reversed)
This setting will appear if your Leica instrument has the power search system. Settings it to this will
reverse the behaviour of the Power Search directional function. If FieldGenius is being operated
onboard then pressing the PS right will turn the instrument left and opposite if FieldGenius is being
operated on a data collector.
PS Absolute Window
This setting will appear if your Leica instrument has the power search system. This will force the
power search system to do a relative search based on the search window range.
- 492 -
Stonex FieldGenius
RC-PR
If you're using a Sokkia SRX, you can set the search mode to RC-PR. This will force the instrument
to use the RC system for the search.
Search Window Range
Use this to define the upper right corner and lower left corner of your search window. Pressing the
measure button will step you through the procedure and it will calculate the horizontal and vertical
search range. This range will be applied to the instrument's current direction when the user presses
the search button.
Search Window Center
Use this to set an absolute center for your search window. The search window range parameters will
be applied to the search window values that were measured. Pressing the measure button will step
you through the procedure and it will calculate the horizontal and vertical search range.
Auto search for prism
If this is checked, then if your instrument has lost its lock on the prism, FieldGenius will automatically
initiate a search for the prism when the measure button is pressed. You will see the word "Search" on
the lock button at the top of the robotic instrument toolbar while a search is in progress.
- 493 -
Total Station Reference
Connect to Instrument
If you're not connected to the instrument you will see a status of "Not Connected" displayed above
the Connect to Instrument button. When you're ready to connect make sure you have done the fol-
lowing:
Once you have done all four steps, you can press the Connect to Instrument button. If you see a
status of "Connected" displayed above the Connect to Instrument button then you have successfully
connected.
- 494 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Getting Started
To start taking measurement you need to exit out the Total Station Configuration screen by pressing
close button. Depending on the instrument you connected to you will have different options available.
Please review the Instrument Toolbar topic for more information.
Tip: You can use the enter key on your device to take a measurement. For example, if your Measure
Mode is set to Sideshot and you press the enter key, your instrument will take a measurement.
- 495 -
Total Station Reference
Communication Settings
FieldGenius has updated its Bluetooth connection process to save all previously connected devices
in a convenient pull down list. To connect to a Bluetooth device from the Instrument Selection screen
choose the type of device you wanting to connect to and Click "Add" button. This will prompt the user
to give the device a unique name and then proceed to the Instrument Profile screen. Now click on the
"Model and Communication" button to take you to the next screen where it will prompt the user for the
make and model of the device you wish to connect to. Press the "Bluetooth Device List" button to
take you to the BT device List screen where you can Search for, Edit or Delete a device.
- 496 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 497 -
Total Station Reference
Other Settings
On the Total Station Configuration screen, you can review the other options to set some additional
parameters for your instrument.
- 498 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Connect to Instrument
If you're not connected to the instrument you will see a status of "Not Connected" displayed above
the Connect to Instrument button. When you're ready to connect make sure you have done the fol-
lowing:
Once you have done all four steps, you can press the Connect to Instrument button. If you see a
status of "Connected" displayed above the Connect to Instrument button then you have successfully
connected.
Getting Started
To start taking measurement you need to exit out the Total Station Configuration screen by pressing
the Connect button. Depending on the instrument you connected to you will have different options
available. Please review the Robotic Instrument Toolbar topic for more information.
No Communication
When trying to communicate with your instrument you will see sometimes see a "No communication
with instrument. Check settings, cables and power." error message if FieldGenius can't make a con-
nection with your instrument.
Usually this happens when your communication parameters are not the same on the instrument and
in FieldGenius. You need to check these settings again to make sure they're correct.
This can also happen if you have a bad cable. If you're using a robotic instrument you might have
setup your radios incorrectly.
- 499 -
Total Station Reference
Use the vertical scroll bar along the side to access additional instrument settings if they cannot all fit
on screen at the same time.
Please note that not every instrument supports each of the following functions, so you may not see all
of the following buttons when connected to your total station.
Level Instrument
This will open the Check Level screen, where you can check how level your instrument is.
Instrument Information
When this is pressed, we will display the current battery status of your instrument. Note, not all instru-
ments support this.
EDM Settings
Use this to set the EDM mode for your instrument. Every manufacturer has different measurement
modes available but we will list only those that your instrument supports. Please refer to your instru-
ment manual for more information on the EDM modes your instrument supports. Any time you change
your EDM Mode, FieldGenius writes a comment into the raw file indicating which mode is being used.
Tolerance settings
This will take you to you measurement tolerance settings.
Set Angle
Use this to open the Set Angle screen where you can view the current angles and turn or flop your
motorized instrument.
- 500 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Auto-Center On / Off
Use this to automatically center the map when a point is shot. If turned on, whenever you take a
measurement, the current prism location will always appear in the center of your map display.
ATR On / Off
Use this to turn on and off your instruments Auto Target Recognition feature.
Laser Pointer On / Off
This turns on and off the instrument's red laser pointer.
Guide Lights On / Off
This will turn on and off your instrument's guide lights.
Instrument Joystick
This is the Total Station Joystick function. When activated you will be able to move your motorized
instrument to the left, right, up and down by using the joystick touch-screen. There are three speeds
that can be activated: slow, medium, and fast. The smaller inside blue buttons activate the slowest
turn mode, and the larger outside blue buttons activate the fastest turn mode. To stop the instrument
from turning, simply press the red Stop button at the center. The directions assume you are at the
pole looking at the instrument. Pressing the right buttons will turn the instrument to your right,
pressing the up buttons will turn the scope up, etc.
Instrument Connect / Disconnect
Use this to connect or disconnect FieldGenius from the instrument. When you are connected to the
instrument you will see the Disconnect Instrument button.
Rotate Instrument
Total Station Toolbar | Instrument Settings | Rotate Instrument
You can access this screen by pressing the Rotate Instrument button on the Total Station Settings
screen.
- 501 -
Total Station Reference
- 502 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Check Level
Total Station Toolbar | Settings | Level Instrument
If your instrument supports it, you can check to see how level your instrument is.
Plummet Intensity
If your instrument has a laser plummet or laser pointer, FieldGenius can toggle those functions on or
off. On some models of total station this feature is turned on automatically.
Division
You can now adjust the sensitivity of your display to show 20, 30, and 60 second intervals.
Tolerance
You can now set a tolerance for the level bubble sensor. If you exceed that tolerance then you will
receive a warning message that indicates your instrument is out of level. You can also set the tol-
erance level to OFF, which basically turns off the tilt compensator on the instrument. Please note that
turning the compensator off can greatly affect the quality of the data surveyed.
Check Level Every Shot
Use this option to force our software to check instrument level before every measurement. The
default is off.
Basic Measure
Total Station Toolbar | Instrument Settings | Basic Measure
Total Station Onboard
The Basic Measure mode is a quick way for the user to setup and take a quick measurement without
having a Project or a total station setup and provides a direct view of the angular and distance values.
However using this mode will not allow the observation to be stored to the database or RAW file.
- 503 -
Total Station Reference
Options
Plate Angle
Users can define a desired plate angle to be applied to the current orientation.
Set Laser Pointer
Toggles Laser Pointer ON/OFF
Target Manager
Target Manager allows the users to toggle between Prisms and EDM modes.
Note: Basic Measure mode does not take Target Height into consideration.
Measure
Initiates an observation from the Total Station.
OK
Pressing this button with FieldGenius onboard Total Station will take the user to the Project Manager.
Target Manager
Total Station Toolbar | Target Manager
The Target Manager is a place where you can manage your EDM (electronic distance measurement)
targets. You can create, edit, copy, and delete targets.
- 504 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Target
Press this button to select a backsight target from the Prism Selection window.
Target Height
Enter the height of your target here.
Press the Set Default Height button to assign the default height to this Target
Height field. The default height is defined in the Default Settings screen.
EDM Mode
Use this field to select the EDM Mode you would like to use. You will only be able to select an EDM
mode that corresponds to your target type.
Prism Constant
This field will display whatever prism constant that you entered for the selected target.
OK
This records the settings you have just made, closes the Target Manager, and returns you to the
MapView.
- 505 -
Total Station Reference
Target List
Press this button to access the Target List. The Target List consists of user-defined and default instru-
ment targets. Here you can create, copy, edit, and delete targets.
Default Settings
Press this button to access the Default Settings screen. This is where you define the default target
heights.
Cancel
Press this button to discard any changed made to the Backsight dialog and returns you to the
MapView.
Target
Press this button to select a foresight target from the Prism Selection window.
Target Height
Enter the height of your foresight target here.
Press the Set Default Height button to assign the default target height to this Tar-
get Height field. The default height is defined in the Default Settings screen.
- 506 -
Stonex FieldGenius
EDM Mode
Use this field to select the EDM Mode you would like to use. Typically you will want to select an EDM
Mode that corresponds to your target type.
Use Temp. Height
Press this button to activate the Temporary Height function (button is active in the above image). To
enable the temporary height be used, you must press the Use Temp. Height button. Once activated,
the following measurement will use this temporary height but it will be a one-time measurement, and
then the system will immediately revert back to the height defined in the Target Height field. This is
handy if you need to take a quick shot using a different height such as when measuring an invert.
Press the Set Default Height button to assign the default Temporary height to
this Target Height field. The default height is defined in the Default Settings
screen
Prism Constant
This field will display whatever prism offset that you entered for the selected target.
OK
This records the settings you have just made, closes the Target Manager, and returns you to the
MapView.
Cancel
Press this button to discard any changed made to the Backsight dialog and returns you to the
MapView.
- 507 -
Total Station Reference
Press the button labelled with the desired prism to use to set it as the Prism for either the backsight or
foresight.
Target List
Press this button to access the Target List. Here you can create, copy, edit, and delete targets.
Cancel
Press this button to go back to the Target Manager window.
Target List
Total Station Toolbar | Target Manager | Target List
The Target List is where you can create, edit, copy, and delete targets. The Target List comes with 2
default targets (Default Prism and Default Reflectorless) but you can create as many more as you
like. All targets are saved in the Settings.xml file and is located in the Programs folder.
- 508 -
Stonex FieldGenius
You are not permitted to delete or edit a default target but you certainly can copy one and edit the
copy.
New
Tap on this button to access the New Target dialog. Here you can create a new target.
Edit
Tap on a target to select it. Then press the Edit button to access the Edit Target dialog. Default tar-
gets cannot be edited.
Delete
Tap on a target to select it. Then press the Delete button to delete the selected target. You will
receive a warning message that you must acknowledge before deletion is complete. Default targets
cannot be deleted.
Copy
Tap on a target to select it. Then press the Copy button. This will open the Edit Target dialog and you
can then edit the copied parameters.
Close
Pressing this button returns you to the Target Manager screen.
New Target
Total Station Toolbar | Target Manager | Target List | New
- 509 -
Total Station Reference
Use this option to create a new target. Provide the new target with a unique name, a prism constant,
and select an icon to represent your new target.
Target Name
Use this field to either edit or enter a new name for the target you are editing.
Target Type
There are two target types available to select. Prism is to be used when you are selecting a target
that has a known offset. This can be a round prism, 360, mini, etc. RL stands for reflectorless and
you should select this target type if you are using an instrument that is reflectorless capable and you
do not wish to use a designated reflector.
Prism Icon
Use this field to select an icon for your new target.
Prism Constant
This defines the relation of the distance measurement to the mechanical reference point of the
reflector. Your prism will have a published prism constant (also called and offset).
Save
Press this button to store your new changes to the Settings.xml file, and return you to the Target List
screen.
Cancel
Press this button to cancel creating a new target. You will be returned to the Target List screen.
- 510 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Edit Target
Total Station Toolbar | Target Manager | Target List | Edit
Use this option to edit an existing target. You will also see this display after you copy an existing tar-
get.
Target Name
Use this field to either edit or enter a new name for the target you are editing.
Target Type
There are two target types available to select. Prism is to be used when you are selecting a target
that has a known offset. This can be a round prism, 360, mini, etc. RL stands for reflectorless and
you should select this target type if you are using an instrument that is reflectorless capable and you
do not wish to use a designated reflector.
Prism Icon
Use this field to select an icon for your new target.
Prism Constant (mm)
This defines the relation of the distance measurement to the mechanical reference point of the
reflector. Your prism will have a published offset.
- 511 -
Total Station Reference
Save
Press this button to store your new changes to the Settings.xml file, and return you to the Target List
screen.
Cancel
Press this button to cancel creating a new target. You will be returned to the Target List screen.
Default Settings
Total Station Toolbar | Target Manager | Default Settings
The Default Settings screen is where you can define the default target heights for prism targets, RL
(reflectorless) targets, and a temporary height. The temporary height value is used for taking a one-
time measurement using the height value entered in this field. After the measurement is completed,
the system will revert back to using the current target height.
Prism Height
Enter your most common prism height into this field. When you press the Use Default Height button
in the Target Manager screen, this value will populate the Target Height field. This is convenient
when you have a standard prism height and want to assign it quickly.
Important Note: You must be in a prism measure mode to be able to use the Default Height button
in the Target Manager screen and have it use a default prism height.
- 512 -
Stonex FieldGenius
RL Height
Enter your most common ReflectorLess (RL) height into this field. When you press the Use Default
Height button in the Target Manager screen, this value will populate the Target Height field with this
default height.
Important Note: You must be using a reflectorless measure mode to populate this field using the
Default Height button in the Target Manager screen, and have it use the default reflectorless height.
Temporary Height
The temporary height function works as a one-time measurement using the height entered into this
field. After the measurement has completed, the target height will revert back to the height that had
been defined in the Target Height field. This is very handy when you want to take a quick one-time
measurement such as for when measuring an invert.
Set instrument prism constant to zero
If this has a check mark in the box, a prism constant of zero will be uploaded to your instrument. The
offsets specified in the foresight and backsight targets will be applied to the measurements when
received by FieldGenius. Remove the check mark if you don't want FieldGenius to modify your instru-
ment's prism offset. Not all instruments support this feature.
When you connect your instrument to FieldGenius, special notes are recorded in the raw file regarding
prism offsets.
If you have the ”Set Instrument” toggle turned on and your instrument supports this feature,
FieldGenius will set your instrument's prism offset to zero so no correction will be applied to the meas-
urement. Then once FieldGenius receives this uncorrected measurement, it will use the values you
specified in the prism offset fields and adjust the distance accordingly. For example, if you specified
an offset of 30mm, FieldGenius will upload an offset of zero to your instrument and apply the 30 mm
offset to the measurement after it is received. In your raw file you will see the following note:
--FieldGenius Prism: 30mm Instrument Prism: 0mm
Most prism offset are specified in millimeters. FieldGenius will make the necessary conversions so
the proper adjustment is applied.
If FieldGenius can't set the prism offset on your instrument, it usually can't read it either. Since a
prism offset wasn't uploaded, we don't know what prism offset is set on the instrument. So we indic-
ate this by writing to the raw file that the instrument prism offset is "unknown".
--FieldGenius Prism: 30mm Instrument Prism: Unknown
When this happens you will usually want to confirm what offset are currently configured on your instru-
ment in regards to prism offsets.
Special Notes:
- 513 -
Total Station Reference
- When using instruments that don't support uploading of prism constants, be sure not
to double up your prism offsets by applying it in the instrument and FieldGenius at the
same time.
- Since prism offsets are so important, on the measurement progress meter you will
see what offset is being applied to your measurement.
OK
Pressing this button will save your changes in this dialog, and return you to the Target Manager.
Cancel
Pressing this button will ignore your changes in this dialog and return you to the Target Manager.
- 514 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 515 -
GNSS Reference
GNSS REFERENCE
Create/Edit GNSS Profile
Select GNSS Profile
Main Menu | Connect
This is where you can create a new profile for each rover/base receiver you will be using.
There are two ways to get to this screen.
1. You can open the profile screen for your rover or base by going to Main Menu | Settings | Instru-
ment Selection. This will display the Instrument Selection screen which contains the GNSS
Rover and GNSS Reference profiles.
2. If you already have your instrument type set to GNSS and you're currently in the map view,
you can press the Settings button on the GNSS toolbar. This will display the Instrument Selec-
tion screen which contains the GNSS Rover and GNSS Reference profiles.
Editing Profiles
On the Add Profile screen you can enter any name you wish for the profile. Profiles can be copied
from one data collector to another, so you can have a "Master" profile file that is sent to all crews so
they can quickly set up systems.
- 516 -
Stonex FieldGenius
When you're ready to edit the settings for the profile you have selected, press the Edit button. This
will display the GNSS configuration screen for the selected rover or reference profile.
Refer to the GNSS Configuration (Reference) or GNSS Configuration (Rover) topics for more inform-
ation on the settings available for your profiles.
Your profiles are stored in the Settings.xml file within the ...\Stonex\FieldGenius\FG Projects\ (Win-
dows CE/Mobile) or ...\Documents\Stonex\FieldGenius\FG Projects\ (Windows Tablet/PC) directory
so once you have configured one data collector, you can copy this file onto other data collectors to
make the profiles available on them. This file should also be backed up for easy recovery.
Using Profiles for Connection
Once you've created your profiles, you can use them to connect to your receiver. Simply select the
correct GNSS Mode, either GNSS Rover or GNSS Reference, then select the profile you want to use
in the profile list.
When you've physically connected the data collector to your receiver, press the Connect button to
start the connection process.
If it isn't successful you will see the following message "Could not detect GNSS receiver! Please
check configuration, cable and power." You can then press the Auto Detect Baud Rate button to force
FieldGenius to automatically try different baud rate settings. If this doesn't work you should review
your profile settings and ensure that you have the correct COM port selected and that you have your
data collector connected to the correct port on the GNSS receiver.
- 517 -
GNSS Reference
- 518 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 519 -
GNSS Reference
Model
Specify the make and model of receiver you are connecting to.
Sensor Port
If your receiver has more than one data port, specify the port on the receiver that the data collector will
be connected to.
Port
Specify the port on your data collector (usually COM1) that you will connect a cable between your
receiver and this port.
- 520 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Please note that not all Bluetooth-enabled devices will list Bluetooth as a Port option.
In some cases you must configure and use a virtual COM port through Windows CE's
internal Bluetooth Settings, for example COM6.
Bluetooth Search
If you set the port to Bluetooth, a Bluetooth Search button will appear. Press the search button to
find the device you want to communicate wirelessly with. All devices within range will be listed,
choose the one you want to use
The device you selected will be saved into your instrument profile for future use so you do not need to
Search every time.
- 521 -
GNSS Reference
Bluetooth PIN
After initiating a Bluetooth connection, you will be prompted to enter the PIN (passkey) for the instru-
ment you are connecting to. If your instrument does not need one just leave it blank and continue by
pressing OK.
The PIN you enter will be encrypted and stored in your instrument profile.
SVs Mask
The SVs Mask setting is used to establish the minimum number of satellites that are necessary to pro-
duce a solution with a valid position. The SVs must also pass the elevation mask test to be included
in this number for the calculation of the rover position.
PDOP Mask
The PDOP mask is used to control the acceptable geometry of the satellites used to compute the
RTK position. If the PDOP value exceeds this number, the user will not be eligible to collect an RTK
position.
- 522 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Elevation Mask
The Elevation Mask is used to determine which satellites to use in computing the differential cor-
rections to broadcast to the rover(s). Satellites below this value will not be used in the solution. Elev-
ation mask angles are typically equal or less than the elevation mask set for the rover system.
You can define three different tolerance modes that can be selected from the Sensor Configure option
in the GNSS Settings menu while surveying. Tolerance settings are used to ensure that certain cri-
teria are being met every time you take a measurement. The reason for three different settings is to
allow you to specify different tolerances for different types of measurements you might need to make.
For example, control points would need to be measured more precisely then those used for topo-
graphic measurements.
Description
This is where you can assign a "friendly" description to your three tolerance modes to make them
more easily identifiable to you - for example "Control Points" or "Topo Points".
- 523 -
GNSS Reference
Options
Real Time
Toggle to set the Tolerance Settings for RTK.
Observations
This is the minimum number of observations that the receiver must collect and average in order to
compute a solution.
Solution
Each observation must be of the specified solution type (or better). You can select from several Solu-
tion modes depending on your receiver make and model, these can be:
l Autonomous
l SBAS (Satellite-based Augmentation System)
l DGPS (Differential Global Positioning System)
l RTK Float (Differential Carrier Solution)
l RTK Fixed (Differential Carrier Solution)
Please refer to your GNSS manufacturer's documentation for the solutions' respective positional
accuracy.
Elevation Mask
The elevation mask is used to filter out satellites that are close to the horizon and are, thus, unre-
liable. Typical elevation mask angles can range between 10º and 20º.
PDOP
The PDOP (Position Dilution of Precision) mask is used to control the acceptable geometry of the
satellites used to compute the solution. If the PDOP value exceeds this number, the user will not be
eligible to collect a position. Typical PDOP masks are 5 or 6.
Satellites Computed
The Satellites mask is used to establish the minimum number of satellites that are necessary to pro-
duce a solution with a valid position. Each satellite must also pass the elevation mask test to be
included in this number for the calculation of the rover position.
- 524 -
Stonex FieldGenius
StdDev Horizontal
FieldGenius will use the instantaneous Standard Deviation values that your receiver is outputting to
determine if the measurement can proceed. If the instantaneous Standard Deviation values are equal
to or less than the values you've specified, then the measurement can proceed. Once this happens,
FieldGenius will start averaging the measurements and will compute and display averaged Standard
Deviation values. These averaged Standard Deviation values must then remain equal to or less than
the values you've specified for the entire duration of the measurement, for the measurement to be
accepted as being within the specified tolerances.
This is your maximum acceptable horizontal standard deviation to be maintained during the point
measurement.
StdDev Vertical
This is your maximum acceptable vertical standard deviation to be maintained during the point meas-
urement.
Correction Age
The maximum time (in seconds) since correction data was received.
Point Tolerance
Point Tolerance - Observations
This is the minimum number of observations that the receiver must collect and average in order to
compute a solution.
Point Tolerance - Time
This is the minimum time duration that the receiver must collect and average observations in order to
compute a solution.
Post Processing Tolerances
These settings apply when using FieldGenius to collect static data for later post processing.
Please note that FieldGenius does not support collecting raw data on all GNSS receivers, please
refer to the Raw Data Logging topic for additional details including a list of receivers which support
this function.
Usage
This option determines whether FieldGenius should use Post Process mode to collect static data for
later post processing.
Selecting Always instructs FieldGenius to automatically switch into Post Process mode to collect
static data for all points.
- 525 -
GNSS Reference
Selecting Auto Start instructs FieldGenius to automatically switch into Post Process mode to collect
static data for the point currently being measured, if the current solution masks are not met.
Selecting Manual allows you to switch into Post Process mode to collect static data for any point as
it is being measured, but FieldGenius will not do so automatically.
Time - Less than 5 SVs
This defines the duration of the static collection if the minimum number of satellites being tracked dur-
ing the static session is 4 satellites. Default = 30 minutes.
If at any time the number of satellites drops below 4 (which is the minimum number of satellites
required to post process a 3D solution), the internal clock timing the static session will reset to zero
and begin again.
Time - Less than 6 SVs
This defines the duration of the static collection if the minimum number of satellites being tracked dur-
ing the static session is 5 satellites. Default = 25 minutes.
Time - Less than 7 SVs
This defines the duration of the static collection if the minimum number of satellites being tracked dur-
ing the static session is 6 satellites. Default = 20 minutes.
Time - Less than 8 SVs
This defines the duration of the static collection if the minimum number of satellites being tracked dur-
ing the static session is 7 satellites. Default = 15 minutes.
Time - 8 or more SVs
This defines the duration of the static collection if the minimum number of satellites being tracked dur-
ing the static session is 8 or more satellites. Default = 10 minutes.
- 526 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Depending on the model you've selected, manufacturer specific antenna offsets will be listed. If your
specific antenna model is not listed, you can select "User Supplied" and specify appropriate offset
measurements. For more detailed information about these offsets, refer to your users guide for your
receiver.
The true height is simply computed by the use of Pythagoras' theorem:
TrueHeight = VerticalOffset + sqrt( (MeasuredHeight)2 - (HorizontalOffset)2 )
You can change the true or measured antenna height at any time, on the Store Point screen when stor-
ing your GNSS shots.
- 527 -
GNSS Reference
- 528 -
Stonex FieldGenius
l Vertical and horizontal distance introduced by the pole tilt will be compensated automatically if
desired.
l Eliminate the need to focus on the conventional bubble on the GNSS pole while taking meas-
urements.
l Stop user from saving points if the pole tilt angle is greater than tolerance level.
The Electronic Bubble feature requires calibrations before being used in production works. With a sup-
ported GNSS receiver connected, Settings and Calibrations related to the Electronic Bubble can be
located in the Settings | Sensor Configure | Electronic Bubble screen.
- 529 -
GNSS Reference
Settings
Electronic Bubble
Toggles Electronic Bubble feature ON/OFF
Tilt Compensated
Toggles tilt compensation ON/OFF
With tilt compensation turned on, tilt distance will be added into the calculation of GNSS meas-
urements.
Tilt Rejection
Toggles tilt rejection ON/OFF
With tilt rejection turned on, user will not be able to store points if the tilt angle exceeds the specified
rejection tolerance.
Tilt Rejection (Deg)
Tilt rejection tolerance in degrees. User can only store points if only the tilt angle is below the set limit.
Magnetic Declination
Specify the angle between magnetic north and true north
- 530 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Calibrate Sensors
Calibrate Tilt Sensors
This procedure calibrates the internal tilt sensor, and stores the zeroed the vertical angle.
Note: Control panel on the GNSS receiver must be facing the operator when using the electronic
bubble.
Calibrate Magnetic Sensors
This procedure calibrates the internal magnetic sensor.
- 531 -
GNSS Reference
We recommend to perform both calibration procedures on regular basis to ensure the reliability and
accuracy of the Electronic Bubble. Magnetic Sensor may require more frequent calibration than tilt
sensor depending on your calibration location and distance travelled. Consult with your GNSS
receiver manufacture representative for more information regarding calibrate internals.
Settings
Electronic Bubble
After calibration, the electronic bubble can be found in two places.
- 532 -
Stonex FieldGenius
On the GNSS Measurement Screen, if the Tilt Rejection is turned on and current tilt angle exceeds
the preset rejection value, the Store Position button will be deactivated and GNSS measurements will
not be averaged until the GNSS receiver turns to a plumb and stable position.
- 533 -
GNSS Reference
Device
Device Type
Select the appropriate Correction Link device type, such as GSM Module, UHF Radio Module, Data
Collector Internet, or Other Device.
Device Port
Select the appropriate Port when multiple options exist.
- 534 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Device Setup
When you press the Setup button on the dialog above, the Radio Setup or Modem Setup screen will
appear. Choose the radio make and model from the pull-down and set the channel or frequency, the
radio will be programmed by FieldGenius to the channel or frequency selected (on some models). If
you are using an NTRIP or GPRS server, enter your internet and server credentials here.
Correction Data
Message Type
The message type is used in determining what data streams are sent from the reference station to the
rover. They can be RTCM, CMR or a proprietary format.
Base Station ID
Select a specific Base Station ID to restrict message corrections to specific reference stations.
RTCM Transformation
To receive horizontal and vertical coordinate system information from your network, enable RTCM
Transformation messages.
- 535 -
GNSS Reference
OK:
The OK button will only become active if valid transformation messages are received.
Options:
l Coordinate System - Predefined coordinate systems can be used if you no longer wish to use
RTCM transformation. Horizontal and Vertical system can be selected separately.
l Mount Points - A different mount points can be selected if the current mount point do not sup-
port RTCM messages.
l Go Back - Allows you go back to the previous screen and continue waiting for incoming mes-
sages
l Cancel - This button will exit the link configuration work flow and bring out the map view. You
will need to select a valid coordinate system before taking measurement if the RTCM trans-
formation messages are not received.
Correction Information
GNSS Toolbar | Instrument Settings | Link Information
The Correction Information screen is accessed from the GNSS Settings screen. It displays inform-
ation about the correction message being received by your receiver via a radio link from a base
receiver, or via a cellular modem link from an NTRIP or GPRS server.
- 536 -
Stonex FieldGenius
For information on configuring your correction link please see the Correction Link topic.
The Satellite Plot screen is a graphical representation of the current GNSS satellite constellation. It
shows all visible satellites including both GPS and GLONASS. Those satellites being used in the cur-
rent solution are indicated with a black dot, and those being ignored are indicated with a white dot.
Each satellite is displayed with its PRN (identification) number, and the Elevation Mask specified in
your current Tolerance Mode is indicated by a red dashed line.
Press the View List button to open the Satellite List screen.
Press the Satellite Setup button to enable/disable constellations.
- 537 -
GNSS Reference
The Satellite List screen displays information on the current GNSS satellite constellation. It shows all
visible satellites including both GPS and GLONASS. Those satellites being used in the current solu-
tion are indicated with a checkmark, and those being ignored are indicated with an X.
Each satellite is displayed with its PRN (identification) number, Azimuth and Elevation, and Signal-
to-Noise Ratio.
- 538 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Press the View Plot button to open the Satellite Plot screen.
Press the Close button to return to the map screen.
GNSS Settings
- 539 -
GNSS Reference
Sensor Configure
This will allow you to make changes to most of the settings in your reference or rover profile, including
configuring the three tolerance modes, selecting the active tolerance mode, configuring the antenna
height, configuring the auto-recording options and depending on the GNSS Sensor connected, the
Electronic Bubble settings will be shown here as well. (The Model and Communication options can-
not be configured while you are connected to your GNSS receiver.)
- 540 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Sensor Information
The Sensor Information screen displays detailed information about the hardware you are connected
to.
Link Configure
This turns on your GNSS Receiver's radio or modem to begin receiving RTK corrections, from either
a base receiver or an NTRIP or GPRS server.
- 541 -
GNSS Reference
Link Information
The Link Information screen displays detailed real-time information about the correction message
being received by your receiver via a radio link from a base receiver, or via a cellular modem link from
an NTRIP or GPRS server.
Position Information
The Position Information screen displays detailed real-time information about your current position.
- 542 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Antenna Height
The Antenna Height screen allows you to configure the antenna height of your GNSS receiver.
- 543 -
GNSS Reference
Sensor Information
GNSS Toolbar | Instrument Settings | Sensor Information
- 544 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The Sensor Information screen is accessed from the GNSS Settings screen. It displays information
about the hardware you are connected to. The specific information available will vary by model, but
typically you will see the make and model of your receiver, its serial number, battery status, firmware
information, and more.
Position Information
GNSS Toolbar | Instrument Settings | Position Information
The Position Information screen is accessed from the GNSS Settings screen. It displays detailed
information about your current position.
- 545 -
GNSS Reference
- 546 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Note: FieldGenius cannot control the data logging on all models of GNSS receivers. Currently, we
support data logging on the:
Acnovo GX9 GINTEC G9
Pentax SMT888-3G Rev 2
Acnovo GX10 GINTEC G10
Prexiso G4/G5
Altus APS-3 Hemisphere S320
Septentrio Altus APS3G
Altus APS-3G Hemisphere S321
Septentrio Altus NR2
Altus APS-NR2 Horizon Kronos C3
Sokkia GRX1
Ashtech / Thales ProMark 500 Javad Triumph-1
Sokkia GSR2600
Ashtech / Thales ProMark 800 KOLIDA K5 Plus
SOUTH GALAXY G1/G1 Plus
Champion AllStar LINERTEC LGN-200S
SOUTH GALAXY G6
Champion Pro Leica 1200
SOUTH S82/S82-V
CHC i80 Leica GS15
SOUTH S86
CHC X900+ Leica GS10
Spectra Precision SP80
CHC X91+ Leica SmartRover
STONEX S8 Plus
ComNav T300 Leica GPS900
STONEX S9i
geo-FENNEL FGS 1 NavCom SF-3040
STONEX S9III Plus
GeoMax Zenith10 NavCom SF-3050
STONEX S10
GeoMax Zenith15 NovAtel DL4
Topcon GR-3
GeoMax Zenith20 Pentax G3100-R1
Topcon HiPer
GeoMax Zenith25/25Pro Pentax G3100-R2
Z-SURVEY Z6
GeoMax Zenith35/35Pro Pentax SMT888-3G
- 547 -
GNSS Reference
Command Console
GNSS Toolbar | Instrument Settings | Command Console
The Command Console screen is accessed from the GNSS Settings screen. It allows you to send
commands to your receiver to configure settings, or other related tasks.
You must determine the exact syntax to enter in the console and you can usually gather this inform-
ation from your GNSS manufacturer.
Send
This will send the parameters that you've entered to your receiver.
Run Script
This allows you to import and read a text file that has a sequence of commands that you would like to
upload to your receiver.
Clear Console
This will clear console of all parameters sent and received from your receiver.
- 548 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 549 -
Disto/Laser Reference
DISTO/LASER REFERENCE
Main Menu | Connect | Disto/Laser
3D Disto
To use a 3D Disto:
l Having a serial number starting with 175 or 177 requires the 3D Disto Software for Windows
installed on your computer to make the initial USB or WiFi connection. These devices also are
recommended to be used with a USB WiFi stick for WiFi connectivity.
l Having a serial number starting with 176 will connect automatically without the 3D Disto Soft-
ware for Windows, and does not require a USB WiFi stick.
FieldGenius supports live video streaming from the 3D Disto camera into the MapView area. Use the
controls at the edges of the video image to turn the 3D Disto, or tap on the image to turn to the point.
Measuring
To measure a location simply press the measure button in FieldGenius.
Staking
To stakeout a location simply start any of the Staking routines. The 3D Disto will automatically turn to
the point you are trying to locate. Press the measure button to calculate a position.
- 550 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Additional Information
The following topics make use of the 3D Disto
- 551 -
Disto/Laser Reference
1. Only required for devices having serial numbers starting with 175 or 177:
l Download the latest 3D Disto software for Windows from Leica myWorld.
l Install the 3D Disto software and run it.
l In the 3D Disto software, select the Connect USB or Connect WiFi button to con-
nect:
l Once connected, the main screen of the 3D Disto software will be displayed. The com-
munication ports are now configured on the PC/Tablet.
l Close the 3D Disto software.
2. Launch FieldGenius and open a Project.
3. At the Instrument Selection screen, pick the Disto/Laser type and choose the pre-configured
3D Disto profile, then pick Edit:
- 552 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 553 -
Disto/Laser Reference
6. Complete, see the Measure Modes (Disto/Laser) topic for supported functionality.
S910 Disto
The Leica S910 Disto is fully supported using a WiFi connection. It can be operated using workflows
very similar to a Total Station when combined with a tripod or stand. Without a tripod or stand, the
S910 can be used to capture distances for various applications, including:
5. Complete, see the Measure Modes (Disto/Laser) topic for supported functionality.
- 554 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Bluetooth Disto
FieldGenius supports handheld Leica Distos with Bluetooth connectivity. Supported models include
Disto A6 and D330i. Bluetooth LE is not currently supported (E7100i, E7500i, etc.). Supported mod-
els are able to capture distances for various applications, including:
- 555 -
Connecting to Computer
CONNECTING TO COMPUTER
Microsoft ActiveSync / Windows Mobile Device Center
Microsoft ActiveSync and Microsoft Windows Mobile Device Center facilitate communication
between your PC and your handheld device.
If you are using Windows XP or earlier, Microsoft ActiveSync has to be installed on your computer
so you can download data between your hand held and desktop computers. The current version (at
time of printing) is ActiveSync 4.5. You may have to use an earlier version if you are running Windows
95 or 98. Check the web page noted below for more information.
If you are using Windows Vista, Microsoft Windows Mobile Device Center has to be installed on
your computer, rather than Microsoft ActiveSync. The current version (at time of printing) is Windows
Mobile Device Center 6.1.
- 556 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Connect your handheld data collector to your desktop or laptop computer using the supplied cradle
and/or cables.
- 557 -
Connecting to Computer
Power ON the data collector and click Next on the Get Connected Wizard. Some devices require you
to tap a PC Link icon on the device while the Get Connected function is in operation.
When communication is established, you will be prompted to set up a partnership between your data
collector and the desktop computer.
Note: If your device does not connect as shown, turn the device off, and then back on again to retry
Establish a Guest Connection
After you successfully connect to your computer, you will be asked to setup a partnership. Choose
Guest Partnership then click Next to continue.
Note:
You can setup a Standard Partnership if desired, but this is not necessary and adds
complexity. We recommend using a Guest Partnership.
- 558 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Or if you are using a handheld device running Windows Mobile 5.0 or newer, you may instead see the
Synchronization Setup Wizard, simply press Cancel to use a guest connection.
- 559 -
Connecting to Computer
You are now ready to move on to the next step - Stonex Transfer Program
Note:
A small circular ActiveSync icon will appear in the lower right corner of your desktop
(like the one at right in the above image). This will display in gray when ActiveSync is
inactive but will change to green when your device is connected.
MicroSurvey Transfer
We provide a free transfer tool with FieldGenius to help you copy Projects to and from your data col-
lector. The program is called Stonex Transfer and it can be download from our website or installed dir-
ectly off of the CD provided with FieldGenius.
Once installed all you need is to connect your handheld computer to your desktop computer via an
ActiveSync or Windows Mobile Device Center connection. ActiveSync is a Microsoft Windows
product which establishes a serial or USB connection between your data collector and your com-
puter.
Once connected, you can start the Stonex Transfer program.
- 560 -
Stonex FieldGenius
The program has been designed to streamline the transfer of Projects and files back and forth
between you data collector and computer.
For more details, please refer to the Help file included with the Stonex Transfer program.
Synchronize
To import your Projects into your Stonex Geomatics CAD desktop product, please refer to the
FieldGenius SyncWizard topic in the Stonex Geomatics CAD help file.
- 561 -
RAW File Reference
BK - Backsight Record
A backsight record is written to the raw file when you complete an occupy point command. Please
review the Setup Occupy Point topic for more information.
Field headers:
OP: Occupy point
BP: Back point
BS: Backsight
BC: Back circle
BK,OP101,BP100,BS0.00000,BC0.00000
CF - Cut Sheet
When you stake out a point, a CF record will be recorded in the raw file.
- 562 -
Stonex FieldGenius
ST: Station
OD: Offset direction (ENUM)
OL: Offset length
EL: Elevation
GD: Grade (design)
JB - Job Record
Every time a raw file is created or opened a JB record will be written to the file.
Field headers:
NM: Job name
DT: Date
TM: Time
JB,NMTraverse1,DT03-05-2004,TM14:07:52
- 563 -
RAW File Reference
Field headers:
OP: Point number
N : Northing (the header is N space)
E : Easting (the header is E space)
EL: Elevation
--: Description
OC,OP101,N 1000.0000,E 1000.0000,EL10.0000,--
- 564 -
Stonex FieldGenius
OF,AR90.00000,ZE90.00000,SD50.0000
OF,ZE60.00000,--Vert Angle Offset
OF,OL45.00000,--Right Angle Offset
OF,HD-10.0000,--Horizontal Distance Offset
OF,LR0.0000,--Left / Right Offset
OF,VD0.0000,--Elevation Offset
Offset shots will always contain the original measurement plus the offset information. You will also
see a SS record accompany the OF records and it will contain the reduced measurement. Following
is an example of a distance offset where an offset of -10 was entered:
OF,AR180.00000,ZE90.00000,SD50.0000
OF,HD-10.0000,--Horizontal Distance Offset
OF,LR0.0000,--Left / Right Offset
OF,VD0.0000,--Elevation Offset
LS,HI1.500,HR1.500
SS,OP1,FP5,AR180.00000,ZE90.00000,SD40.0000,--<No Desc>
RB – Repeat Backsight
When using the multiset function, a RB record will be recorded to the raw file for each backsight shot
you measure. Please refer to the Muti-Set topic for more information.
Field headers:
OP: Occupied point
BP: Backsight point
AR: Angle right
ZE: Zenith angle
SD: Slope distance
HR: Height of rod
RB,OP333,BP100,AR79.48560,ZE93.42500,SD1.9700,HR1.500,--
RF - Repeat Foresight
When you use the multiset function, a RF record will be recorded to the raw file for each foresight shot
you measure. Please refer to the Muti-Set topic for more information.
OP: Occupied point
FP: Foresight point
AR: Angle right
ZE: Zenith angle
- 565 -
RAW File Reference
RE - Remote Elevation
When you use the Benchmark Shot function a RE record will be recorded in the raw file. RE records
will be accompanied by a SP record.
The FE value will be defined by the Benchmark Method selected by the user as being either an exist-
ing point or a user entered value. Please refer to the Measure Benchmark topic for more information.
OP: Occupied point
FE: Foresight elevation
ZE: Zenith angle
SD: Slope distance
--: ( always "Remote elev")
RE,OP1,FE10.000,ZE90.00000,SD50.0000,--Remote elev
RS - Resection
When you use the resection function a RS record will be recorded for each observation made to your
control points. Please refer to the Resection topic for more information.
PN: Point number
CR: Circular reading
ZE: Zenith (or VA, CE)
SD: Slope distance (or HD)
RS,PN103,CR2.42220,ZE90.00000,SD25.0980
When you complete a resection the control points you used will be written as SP records and after the
RS records you will see one final SP for the computed resection point. An example of a resection is
shown below:
--Resection
SP,PN103,N 3135.070,E 1511.185,EL399.795,--:
SP,PN100,N 3097.874,E 1564.984,EL399.387,--:
LS,HI1.300,HR0.000
RS,PN103,CR2.42220,ZE90.00000,SD25.0980
- 566 -
Stonex FieldGenius
RS,PN100,CR102.26120,ZE90.00000,SD56.3050
SP,PN999,N 3110.000,E 1510.000,EL398.291,--
SD - Stakeout Deltas
When you complete a stakeout by pressing the store point command a SD record will be written to
the raw file. It is the difference between the design location (DE record) and the actual point staked
(SP record).
ND: Delta northing
ED: Delta easting
LD: Delta elevation
- 567 -
RAW File Reference
SP - Store Point
Many routines in FieldGenius will write a SP record to the raw file. SP records contain coordinate
information that can be used for setups, resections, etc…
PN: Point number
N: Northing
E: Easting
EL: Elevation
--: Description
SP,PN103,N 3135.070,E 1511.185,EL399.795,--:
SS - Sideshot
When you record a shot a SS record will be recorded in the raw file. Many other functions also create
a SS record such as when offset and multi set shots are reduced.
OP: Occupy point
FP: Foresight point
AR: Angle right
ZE: Zenith
SD: Slope distance
--: Description
SS,OP1,FP7,AR176.11093,ZE90.00000,SD60.1332,--<No Desc>
TR - Traverse Shot
When you record your shot as a Traverse shot, a TR record will be recorded to the raw file. Please
refer to the Measurement Info and Traverse Report topics for more information.
OP: Occupy point
FP: Foresight point
AR: Angle right
- 568 -
Stonex FieldGenius
ZE: Zenith
SD: Slope distance
--: Description
TR,OP1,FP7,AR176.11093,ZE90.00000,SD60.1332,--<No Desc>
- 569 -
RAW File Reference
CT - Calibration Point
PN: Point Name
DM: Dimensions used (ENUM)
RH: Horizontal residual
RV: Vertical residual
EP - Geodetic Position
When you save the location of a point, its geodetic position is also recorded.
TM: Time
LA: Latitude
LN: Longitude
- 570 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 571 -
RAW File Reference
- 572 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 573 -
Index
- 574 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 575 -
Index
- 576 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 577 -
Index
- 578 -
Stonex FieldGenius
O Point Averaging 65
Point by Arc Mode 106, 267
Observation Toolbar 47
Point by Line Mode 105, 266
Occupy 157
Point Chooser Toolbar 64
Offset 188, 190, 193-194, 202, 305
Point Labels 45, 120
Offset Intersection 304
Point Notes 76
Offset Staking 472
Point on Wall 369
Options 115
Point Patterns 291
GPS 122
Point Scanning 210-211, 217-218, 221
Interface 116
Point Staking Toolbar 352
Point Attributes 118
Point Toolbar 62
Point Labels 120
Points 62
Roading 129
Points Database 408
Staking 123
Position Information 542
System 130
Predetermine Areas 323
Total Station 121
Prism Constant 511
User Input 117
Prism Offsets 489
Orthometric Height 140
Prism Search Settings 491
P Profile 516
Pad 103, 265 Profiles 396, 432
Pan 45 Program Receiver 225
Parcels 397 Program Settings 115
Parcels (XML) 430 Project Files 30
- 579 -
Index
- 580 -
Stonex FieldGenius
- 581 -
Index
T Traverse 177
Traverse / Intersection 300
Target Height 50, 504
Traverse Adjustment 278
Target List 504, 506, 508-509
Traverse Report 273
Target Manager 50, 53, 56, 504, 509
Triangle Calculator 333
TDS 562
Trilateration 205, 245
Technical Support 2
Turn 502
Template 397, 400, 451
Turn Instrument 499
Templates 455, 461
Turn to Point 61
Temporary (No Store) 176
Two Line Intersection 199
temporary height 512
Temporary Height 507 U
Text Notes 77 Unit Settings 130
TGRID 424 Units 34, 38
TIF/TIFF 410 Upload 556
Tilt Offset 235 User Defined Coordinate Systems 405
Tilt Survey 529 Using Active Figures 87
TIN 424
V
Tolerance Modes 523
Tolerances 522 Version 152
Topo Toolbar 57 Vertical Angle Offset 193
Total Station 493, 495 Vertical Balance 278
Total Station Configuration 484 vertical offset 371, 375, 377
Total Station Demo 345 Vertical Plane Projection 207
Total Station Make and Model 484 Vertical Profile 442
Total Station Profile 345 Volume 422
Total Station Toolbar 50 W
Transform 410
Wall 377
Transformation 140, 279, 283-284, 288
Windows Mobile Device Center 556
Translate 309, 314
X
Transmit Corrections 527
XML 394, 397, 410, 430, 432, 461
- 582 -
Stonex FieldGenius
Zoom 45
- 583 -